]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - etc/NEWS
*** empty log message ***
[gnu-emacs] / etc / NEWS
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions.
5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10
11 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
15 so we will look at it and add it to the manual.
16
17 \f
18 * Installation Changes in Emacs 22.1
19
20 ---
21 ** Emacs now supports new configure options `--program-prefix',
22 `--program-suffix' and `--program-transform-name' that affect the names of
23 installed programs.
24
25 ---
26 ** Emacs can now be built without sound support.
27
28 ---
29 ** You can build Emacs with Gtk+ widgets by specifying `--with-x-toolkit=gtk'
30 when you run configure. This requires Gtk+ 2.0 or newer. This port
31 provides a way to display multilingual text in menus (with some caveats).
32
33 ---
34 ** The `emacsserver' program has been removed, replaced with elisp code.
35
36 ---
37 ** By default, Emacs now uses a setgid helper program to update game
38 scores. The directory ${localstatedir}/games/emacs is the normal
39 place for game scores to be stored. This may be controlled by the
40 configure option `--with-game-dir'. The specific user that Emacs uses
41 to own the game scores is controlled by `--with-game-user'. If access
42 to a game user is not available, then scores will be stored separately
43 in each user's home directory.
44
45 ---
46 ** Leim is now part of the Emacs distribution.
47 You no longer need to download a separate tarball in order to build
48 Emacs with Leim.
49
50 +++
51 ** The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual is now part of the distribution.
52
53 The ELisp reference manual in Info format is built as part of the
54 Emacs build procedure and installed together with the Emacs User
55 Manual. A menu item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy
56 accessible (Help->More Manuals->Emacs Lisp Reference).
57
58 ---
59 ** The Introduction to Programming in Emacs Lisp manual is now part of
60 the distribution.
61
62 This manual is now part of the standard distribution and is installed,
63 together with the Emacs User Manual, into the Info directory. A menu
64 item was added to the menu bar that makes it easy accessible
65 (Help->More Manuals->Introduction to Emacs Lisp).
66
67 ---
68 ** New translations of the Emacs Tutorial are available in the following
69 languages: Brasilian, Bulgarian, Chinese (both with simplified and
70 traditional characters), French, and Italian. Type `C-u C-h t' to
71 choose one of them in case your language setup doesn't automatically
72 select the right one.
73
74 ---
75 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
76
77 ---
78 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
79 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
80 the supported image types and their associated dynamic libraries by
81 setting the variable `image-library-alist'.
82
83 ---
84 ** Support for Cygwin was added.
85
86 ---
87 ** Support for FreeBSD/Alpha has been added.
88
89 ---
90 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on S390 machines was added.
91
92 ---
93 ** Support for MacOS X was added.
94 See the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
95
96 ---
97 ** Support for GNU/Linux systems on X86-64 machines was added.
98
99 ---
100 ** Mac OS 9 port now uses the Carbon API by default. You can also
101 create non-Carbon build by specifying `NonCarbon' as a target. See
102 the files mac/README and mac/INSTALL for build instructions.
103
104 ---
105 ** Building with -DENABLE_CHECKING does not automatically build with union
106 types any more. Add -DUSE_LISP_UNION_TYPE if you want union types.
107
108 \f
109 * Changes in Emacs 22.1
110
111 ** New command line option -Q or --quick.
112 This is like using -q --no-site-file, but in addition it also disables
113 the fancy startup screen.
114
115 +++
116 ** New command line option -D or --basic-display.
117 Disables the menu-bar, the tool-bar, the scroll-bars, tool tips, and
118 the blinking cursor.
119
120 +++
121 ** New command line option -nbc or --no-blinking-cursor disables
122 the blinking cursor on graphical terminals.
123
124 +++
125 ** The command line option --no-windows has been changed to
126 --no-window-system. The old one still works, but is deprecated.
127
128 +++
129 ** The -f option, used from the command line to call a function,
130 now reads arguments for the function interactively if it is
131 an interactively callable function.
132
133 +++
134 ** Emacs can now be invoked in full-screen mode on a windowed display.
135 When Emacs is invoked on a window system, the new command-line options
136 `--fullwidth', `--fullheight', and `--fullscreen' produce a frame
137 whose width, height, or both width and height take up the entire
138 screen size. (For now, this does not work with some window managers.)
139
140 +++
141 ** Emacs now displays a splash screen by default even if command-line
142 arguments were given. The new command-line option --no-splash
143 disables the splash screen; see also the variable
144 `inhibit-startup-message' (which is also aliased as
145 `inhibit-splash-screen').
146
147 +++
148 ** New user option `inhibit-startup-buffer-menu'.
149 When loading many files, for instance with `emacs *', Emacs normally
150 displays a buffer menu. This option turns the buffer menu off.
151
152 +++
153 ** Init file changes
154 You can now put the init files .emacs and .emacs_SHELL under
155 ~/.emacs.d or directly under ~. Emacs will find them in either place.
156
157 +++
158 ** Emacs now reads the standard abbrevs file ~/.abbrev_defs
159 automatically at startup, if it exists. When Emacs offers to save
160 modified buffers, it saves the abbrevs too if they have changed. It
161 can do this either silently or asking for confirmation first,
162 according to the value of `save-abbrevs'.
163
164 +++
165 ** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
166 When the file is maintained under version control, that information
167 appears between the position information and the major mode.
168
169 +++
170 ** M-g is now a prefix key.
171 M-g g and M-g M-g run goto-line.
172 M-g n and M-g M-n run next-error (like C-x `).
173 M-g p and M-g M-p run previous-error.
174
175 +++
176 ** M-o now is the prefix key for setting text properties;
177 M-o M-o requests refontification.
178
179 +++
180 ** C-u M-x goto-line now switches to the most recent previous buffer,
181 and goes to the specified line in that buffer.
182
183 When goto-line starts to execute, if there's a number in the buffer at
184 point then it acts as the default argument for the minibuffer.
185
186 +++
187 ** You can now switch buffers in a cyclic order with C-x C-left and
188 (prev-buffer) and C-x C-right (next-buffer). C-x left and C-x right
189 can be used as well.
190
191 +++
192 ** New command `Buffer-menu-toggle-files-only' toggles display of file
193 buffers only in the Buffer Menu. It is bound to `T' in Buffer Menu
194 mode.
195
196 +++
197 ** `buffer-menu' and `list-buffers' now list buffers whose names begin
198 with a space, when those buffers are visiting files. Normally buffers
199 whose names begin with space are omitted.
200
201 ---
202 ** The new options `buffers-menu-show-directories' and
203 `buffers-menu-show-status' let you control how buffers are displayed
204 in the menu dropped down when you click "Buffers" from the menu bar.
205
206 `buffers-menu-show-directories' controls whether the menu displays
207 leading directories as part of the file name visited by the buffer.
208 If its value is `unless-uniquify', the default, directories are
209 shown unless uniquify-buffer-name-style' is non-nil. The value of nil
210 and t turn the display of directories off and on, respectively.
211
212 `buffers-menu-show-status' controls whether the Buffers menu includes
213 the modified and read-only status of the buffers. By default it is
214 t, and the status is shown.
215
216 Setting these variables directly does not take effect until next time
217 the Buffers menu is regenerated.
218
219 +++
220 ** The old bindings C-M-delete and C-M-backspace have been deleted,
221 since there are situations where one or the other will shut down
222 the operating system or your X server.
223
224 +++
225 ** `undo-only' does an undo which does not redo any previous undo.
226
227 +++
228 ** When the undo information of the current command gets really large
229 (beyond the value of `undo-outer-limit'), Emacs discards it and warns
230 you about it.
231
232 +++
233 ** M-SPC (just-one-space) when given a numeric argument N
234 converts whitespace around point to N spaces.
235
236 ---
237 ** New command `kill-whole-line' kills an entire line at once.
238 By default, it is bound to C-S-<backspace>.
239
240 +++
241 ** Yanking text now discards certain text properties that can
242 be inconvenient when you did not expect them. The variable
243 `yank-excluded-properties' specifies which ones. Insertion
244 of register contents and rectangles also discards these properties.
245
246 +++
247 ** The default values of paragraph-start and indent-line-function have
248 been changed to reflect those used in Text mode rather than those used
249 in Indented-Text mode.
250
251 +++
252 ** Movement commands `beginning-of-buffer', `end-of-buffer',
253 `beginning-of-defun', `end-of-defun' do not set the mark if the mark
254 is already active in Transient Mark mode.
255
256 +++
257 ** The parameters of automatic hscrolling can now be customized.
258 The variable `hscroll-margin' determines how many columns away from
259 the window edge point is allowed to get before automatic hscrolling
260 will horizontally scroll the window. The default value is 5.
261
262 The variable `hscroll-step' determines how many columns automatic
263 hscrolling scrolls the window when point gets too close to the
264 window edge. If its value is zero, the default, Emacs scrolls the
265 window so as to center point. If its value is an integer, it says how
266 many columns to scroll. If the value is a floating-point number, it
267 gives the fraction of the window's width to scroll the window.
268
269 The variable `automatic-hscrolling' was renamed to
270 `auto-hscroll-mode'. The old name is still available as an alias.
271
272 +++
273 ** A prefix argument is no longer required to repeat a jump to a
274 previous mark, i.e. C-u C-SPC C-SPC C-SPC ... cycles through the
275 mark ring. Use C-u C-u C-SPC to set the mark immediately after a jump.
276
277 +++
278 ** Marking commands extend the region when invoked multiple times. If
279 you hit M-C-SPC (mark-sexp), M-@ (mark-word), M-h (mark-paragraph), or
280 C-M-h (mark-defun) repeatedly, the marked region extends each time, so
281 you can mark the next two sexps with M-C-SPC M-C-SPC, for example.
282 This feature also works for mark-end-of-sentence, if you bind that to
283 a key. It also extends the region when the mark is active in Transient
284 Mark mode, regardless of the last command. To start a new region with
285 one of marking commands in Transient Mark mode, you can deactivate the
286 active region with C-g, or set the new mark with C-SPC.
287
288 +++
289 ** M-h (mark-paragraph) now accepts a prefix arg.
290 With positive arg, M-h marks the current and the following paragraphs;
291 if the arg is negative, it marks the current and the preceding
292 paragraphs.
293
294 +++
295 ** Some commands do something special in Transient Mark mode when the
296 mark is active--for instance, they limit their operation to the
297 region. Even if you don't normally use Transient Mark mode, you might
298 want to get this behavior from a particular command. There are two
299 ways you can enable Transient Mark mode and activate the mark, for one
300 command only.
301
302 One method is to type C-SPC C-SPC; this enables Transient Mark mode
303 and sets the mark at point. The other method is to type C-u C-x C-x.
304 This enables Transient Mark mode temporarily but does not alter the
305 mark or the region.
306
307 After these commands, Transient Mark mode remains enabled until you
308 deactivate the mark. That typically happens when you type a command
309 that alters the buffer, but you can also deactivate the mark by typing
310 C-g.
311
312 +++
313 ** find-file-read-only visits multiple files in read-only mode,
314 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
315
316 +++
317 ** find-alternate-file replaces the current file with multiple files,
318 when the file name contains wildcard characters.
319
320 +++
321 ** Auto Compression mode is now enabled by default.
322
323 ---
324 ** C-x C-f RET, typing nothing in the minibuffer, is no longer a special case.
325
326 Since the default input is the current directory, this has the effect
327 of specifying the current directory. Normally that means to visit the
328 directory with Dired.
329
330 +++
331 ** When you are root, and you visit a file whose modes specify
332 read-only, the Emacs buffer is now read-only too. Type C-x C-q if you
333 want to make the buffer writable. (As root, you can in fact alter the
334 file.)
335
336 +++
337 ** C-x s (save-some-buffers) now offers an option `d' to diff a buffer
338 against its file, so you can see what changes you would be saving.
339
340 +++
341 ** The commands copy-file, rename-file, make-symbolic-link and
342 add-name-to-file, when given a directory as the "new name" argument,
343 convert it to a file name by merging in the within-directory part of
344 the existing file's name. (This is the same convention that shell
345 commands cp, mv, and ln follow.) Thus, M-x copy-file RET ~/foo RET
346 /tmp RET copies ~/foo to /tmp/foo.
347
348 ---
349 ** When used interactively, `format-write-file' now asks for confirmation
350 before overwriting an existing file, unless a prefix argument is
351 supplied. This behavior is analogous to `write-file'.
352
353 ---
354 ** The variable `auto-save-file-name-transforms' now has a third element that
355 controls whether or not the function `make-auto-save-file-name' will
356 attempt to construct a unique auto-save name (e.g. for remote files).
357
358 +++
359 ** The max size of buffers and integers has been doubled.
360 On 32bit machines, it is now 256M (i.e. 268435455).
361
362 +++
363 ** If the user visits a file larger than `large-file-warning-threshold',
364 Emacs prompts her for confirmation.
365
366 +++
367 ** There's a new face `minibuffer-prompt'.
368 Emacs adds this face to the list of text properties stored in the
369 variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', which is used to display the
370 prompt string.
371
372 ---
373 ** Enhanced visual feedback in *Completions* buffer.
374
375 Completions lists use faces to highlight what all completions
376 have in common and where they begin to differ.
377
378 The common prefix shared by all possible completions uses the face
379 `completions-common-part', while the first character that isn't the
380 same uses the face `completions-first-difference'. By default,
381 `completions-common-part' inherits from `default', and
382 `completions-first-difference' inherits from `bold'. The idea of
383 `completions-common-part' is that you can use it to make the common
384 parts less visible than normal, so that the rest of the differing
385 parts is, by contrast, slightly highlighted.
386
387 +++
388 ** File-name completion can now ignore directories.
389 If an element of the list in `completion-ignored-extensions' ends in a
390 slash `/', it indicates a subdirectory that should be ignored when
391 completing file names. Elements of `completion-ignored-extensions'
392 which do not end in a slash are never considered when a completion
393 candidate is a directory.
394
395 +++
396 ** The completion commands TAB, SPC and ? in the minibuffer apply only
397 to the text before point. If there is text in the buffer after point,
398 it remains unchanged.
399
400 +++
401 ** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
402 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
403 elements are deleted.
404
405 +++
406 ** You can now customize fill-nobreak-predicate to control where
407 filling can break lines. The value is now normally a list of
408 functions, but it can also be a single function, for compatibility.
409
410 We provide two sample predicates, fill-single-word-nobreak-p and
411 fill-french-nobreak-p, for use in the value of fill-nobreak-predicate.
412
413 +++
414 ** require-final-newline now has two new possible values:
415
416 `visit' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's needed
417 when visiting the file.
418
419 `visit-save' means add a newline (as an undoable change) if it's
420 needed when visiting the file, and also add a newline if it's needed
421 when saving the file.
422
423 +++
424 ** The new option mode-require-final-newline controls how certain
425 major modes enable require-final-newline. Any major mode that's
426 designed for a kind of file that should normally end in a newline
427 sets require-final-newline based on mode-require-final-newline.
428 So you can customize mode-require-final-newline to control what these
429 modes do.
430
431 +++
432 ** Control characters and escape glyphs are now shown in the new
433 escape-glyph face.
434
435 +++
436 ** Non-breaking space and hyphens are now prefixed with an escape
437 character, unless the new user variable `show-nonbreak-escape' is set
438 to nil.
439
440 +++
441 ** In graphical mode, with a C program, GUD Tooltips have been extended to
442 display the #define directive associated with an identifier when program is
443 not executing.
444
445 ** Moving or scrolling through images (and other lines) taller that
446 the window now works sensible, by automatically adjusting the window's
447 vscroll property.
448
449 +++
450 ** font-lock-lines-before specifies a number of lines before the
451 current line that should be refontified when you change the buffer.
452 The default value is 1.
453
454 ---
455 ** JIT-lock changes
456
457 *** The default settings for JIT stealth lock parameters are changed.
458 The default value for the user option jit-lock-stealth-time is now 16
459 instead of 3, and the default value of jit-lock-stealth-nice is now
460 0.5 instead of 0.125. The new defaults should lower the CPU usage
461 when Emacs is fontifying in the background.
462
463
464 *** jit-lock can now be delayed with `jit-lock-defer-time'.
465
466 If this variable is non-nil, its value should be the amount of Emacs
467 idle time in seconds to wait before starting fontification. For
468 example, if you set `jit-lock-defer-time' to 0.25, fontification will
469 only happen after 0.25s of idle time.
470
471 *** contextual refontification is now separate from stealth fontification.
472
473 jit-lock-defer-contextually is renamed jit-lock-contextually and
474 jit-lock-context-time determines the delay after which contextual
475 refontification takes place.
476
477 +++
478 ** line-move-ignore-invisible now defaults to t.
479
480 ---
481 ** A menu item "Show/Hide" was added to the top-level menu "Options".
482 This menu allows you to turn various display features on and off (such
483 as the fringes, the tool bar, the speedbar, and the menu bar itself).
484 You can also move the vertical scroll bar to either side here or turn
485 it off completely. There is also a menu-item to toggle displaying of
486 current date and time, current line and column number in the
487 mode-line.
488
489 ---
490 ** Speedbar has moved from the "Tools" top level menu to "Show/Hide".
491
492 +++
493 ** On X, MS Windows, and Mac OS, the blinking cursor's "off" state is
494 now controlled by the variable `blink-cursor-alist'.
495
496 +++
497 ** The X resource cursorBlink can be used to turn off cursor blinking.
498
499 +++
500 ** Emacs can produce an underscore-like (horizontal bar) cursor.
501 The underscore cursor is set by putting `(cursor-type . hbar)' in
502 default-frame-alist. It supports variable heights, like the `bar'
503 cursor does.
504
505 +++
506 ** Display of hollow cursors now obeys the buffer-local value (if any)
507 of `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' in the buffer that the cursor
508 appears in.
509
510 +++
511 ** The variable `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' can now be set to any
512 of the recognized cursor types.
513
514 +++
515 ** The new face `mode-line-inactive' is used to display the mode line
516 of non-selected windows. The `mode-line' face is now used to display
517 the mode line of the currently selected window.
518
519 The new variable `mode-line-in-non-selected-windows' controls whether
520 the `mode-line-inactive' face is used.
521
522 +++
523 ** New display feature: focus follows the mouse from one Emacs window
524 to another, even within a frame. If you set the variable
525 mouse-autoselect-window to non-nil value, moving the mouse to a
526 different Emacs window will select that window (minibuffer window can
527 be selected only when it is active). The default is nil, so that this
528 feature is not enabled.
529
530 +++
531 ** On X, when the window manager requires that you click on a frame to
532 select it (give it focus), the selected window and cursor position
533 normally changes according to the mouse click position. If you set
534 the variable x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position to t, the selected
535 window and cursor position do not change when you click on a frame
536 to give it focus.
537
538 +++
539 ** When you specify a frame size with --geometry, the size applies to
540 all frames you create. A position specified with --geometry only
541 affects the initial frame.
542
543 +++
544 ** You can now customize the use of window fringes. To control this
545 for all frames, use M-x fringe-mode or the Show/Hide submenu of the
546 top-level Options menu, or customize the `fringe-mode' variable. To
547 control this for a specific frame, use the command M-x
548 set-fringe-style.
549
550 +++
551 ** The buffer boundaries (i.e. first and last line in the buffer) may
552 now be marked with angle bitmaps in the fringes. In addition, up and
553 down arrow bitmaps may be shown at the top and bottom of the left or
554 right fringe if the window can be scrolled in either direction.
555
556 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
557 `indicate-buffer-boundaries' to a non-nil value. The default value of
558 this variable is found in `default-indicate-buffer-boundaries'.
559
560 If value is `left' or `right', both angle and arrow bitmaps are
561 displayed in the left or right fringe, resp.
562
563 Value may also be an alist which specifies the presense and position
564 of each bitmap individually.
565
566 For example, ((top . left) (t . right)) places the top angle bitmap
567 in left fringe, the bottom angle bitmap in right fringe, and both
568 arrow bitmaps in right fringe. To show just the angle bitmaps in the
569 left fringe, but no arrow bitmaps, use ((top . left) (bottom . left)).
570
571 +++
572 ** On window systems, lines which are exactly as wide as the window
573 (not counting the final newline character) are no longer broken into
574 two lines on the display (with just the newline on the second line).
575 Instead, the newline now "overflows" into the right fringe, and the
576 cursor will be displayed in the fringe when positioned on that newline.
577
578 The new user option 'overflow-newline-into-fringe' may be set to nil to
579 revert to the old behavior of continuing such lines.
580
581 +++
582 ** When display margins are present in a window, the fringes are now
583 displayed between the margins and the buffer's text area, rather than
584 at the edges of the window.
585
586 +++
587 ** A window may now have individual fringe and scroll-bar settings,
588 in addition to the individual display margin settings.
589
590 Such individual settings are now preserved when windows are split
591 horizontally or vertically, a saved window configuration is restored,
592 or when the frame is resized.
593
594 +++
595 ** `special-display-buffer-names' and `special-display-regexps' now
596 understand two new boolean pseudo-frame-parameters `same-frame' and
597 `same-window'.
598
599 +++
600 ** Changes in C-h bindings:
601
602 C-h e displays the *Messages* buffer.
603
604 C-h followed by a control character is used for displaying files
605 that do not change:
606
607 C-h C-f displays the FAQ.
608 C-h C-e displays the PROBLEMS file.
609
610 The info-search bindings on C-h C-f, C-h C-k and C-h C-i
611 have been moved to C-h F, C-h K and C-h S.
612
613 C-h c, C-h k, C-h w, and C-h f now handle remapped interactive commands.
614
615 - C-h c and C-h k report the actual command (after possible remapping)
616 run by the key sequence.
617
618 - C-h w and C-h f on a command which has been remapped now report the
619 command it is remapped to, and the keys which can be used to run
620 that command.
621
622 For example, if C-k is bound to kill-line, and kill-line is remapped
623 to new-kill-line, these commands now report:
624
625 - C-h c and C-h k C-k reports:
626 C-k runs the command new-kill-line
627
628 - C-h w and C-h f kill-line reports:
629 kill-line is remapped to new-kill-line which is on C-k, <deleteline>
630
631 - C-h w and C-h f new-kill-line reports:
632 new-kill-line is on C-k
633
634 ---
635 ** Help commands `describe-function' and `describe-key' now show function
636 arguments in lowercase italics on displays that support it. To change the
637 default, customize face `help-argument-name' or redefine the function
638 `help-default-arg-highlight'.
639
640 +++
641 ** C-h v and C-h f commands now include a hyperlink to the C source for
642 variables and functions defined in C (if the C source is available).
643
644 +++
645 ** Help mode now only makes hyperlinks for faces when the face name is
646 preceded or followed by the word `face'. It no longer makes
647 hyperlinks for variables without variable documentation, unless
648 preceded by one of the words `variable' or `option'. It now makes
649 hyperlinks to Info anchors (or nodes) if the anchor (or node) name is
650 enclosed in single quotes and preceded by `info anchor' or `Info
651 anchor' (in addition to earlier `info node' and `Info node').
652
653 +++
654 ** The new command `describe-char' (C-u C-x =) pops up a buffer with
655 description various information about a character, including its
656 encodings and syntax, its text properties, how to input, overlays, and
657 widgets at point. You can get more information about some of them, by
658 clicking on mouse-sensitive areas or moving there and pressing RET.
659
660 +++
661 ** New command `display-local-help' displays any local help at point
662 in the echo area. It is bound to `C-h .'. It normally displays the
663 same string that would be displayed on mouse-over using the
664 `help-echo' property, but, in certain cases, it can display a more
665 keyboard oriented alternative.
666
667 ---
668 ** New commands `scan-buf-next-region' and `scan-buf-previous-region'
669 move to the start of the next (previous, respectively) region with
670 non-nil help-echo property and display any help found there in the
671 echo area, using `display-local-help'.
672
673 +++
674 ** New user option `help-at-pt-display-when-idle' allows to
675 automatically show the help provided by `display-local-help' on
676 point-over, after suitable idle time. The amount of idle time is
677 determined by the user option `help-at-pt-timer-delay' and defaults
678 to one second. This feature is turned off by default.
679
680 ---
681 ** New commands to operate on pairs of open and close characters:
682 `insert-pair', `delete-pair', `raise-sexp'.
683
684 +++
685 ** In processing a local variables list, Emacs strips the prefix and
686 suffix are from every line before processing all the lines.
687
688 +++
689 ** `apply-macro-to-region-lines' now operates on all lines that begin
690 in the region, rather than on all complete lines in the region.
691
692 +++
693 ** You can now follow links by clicking Mouse-1 on the link.
694
695 Traditionally, Emacs uses a Mouse-1 click to set point and a Mouse-2
696 click to follow a link, whereas most other applications use a Mouse-1
697 click for both purposes, depending on whether you click outside or
698 inside a link. Now the behavior of a Mouse-1 click has been changed
699 to match this context-sentitive dual behavior.
700
701 Depending on the current mode, a Mouse-2 click in Emacs may do much
702 more than just follow a link, so the new Mouse-1 behavior is only
703 activated for modes which explicitly mark a clickable text as a "link"
704 (see the new function `mouse-on-link-p' for details). The Lisp
705 packages that are included in release 22.1 have been adapted to do
706 this, but external packages may not yet support this. However, there
707 is no risk in using such packages, as the worst thing that could
708 happen is that you get the original Mouse-1 behavior when you click
709 on a link, which typically means that you set point where you click.
710
711 If you want to get the original Mouse-1 action also inside a link, you
712 just need to press the Mouse-1 button a little longer than a normal
713 click (i.e. press and hold the Mouse-1 button for half a second before
714 you release it).
715
716 Dragging the Mouse-1 inside a link still performs the original
717 drag-mouse-1 action, typically copy the text.
718
719 You can customize the new Mouse-1 behavior via the new user options
720 `mouse-1-click-follows-link' and `mouse-1-click-in-non-selected-windows'.
721
722 +++
723 ** Emacs normally highlights mouse sensitive text whenever the mouse
724 is over the text. By setting the new variable `mouse-highlight', you
725 can optionally enable mouse highlighting only after you move the
726 mouse, so that highlighting disappears when you press a key. You can
727 also disable mouse highlighting.
728
729 +++
730 ** You can now customize if selecting a region by dragging the mouse
731 shall not copy the selected text to the kill-ring by setting the new
732 variable mouse-drag-copy-region to nil.
733
734 ---
735 ** mouse-wheels can now scroll a specific fraction of the window
736 (rather than a fixed number of lines) and the scrolling is `progressive'.
737
738 ---
739 ** Unexpected yanking of text due to accidental clicking on the mouse
740 wheel button (typically mouse-2) during wheel scrolling is now avoided.
741 This behavior can be customized via the mouse-wheel-click-event and
742 mouse-wheel-inhibit-click-time variables.
743
744 +++
745 ** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
746
747 +++
748 ** M-x setenv now expands environment variables of the form `$foo' and
749 `${foo}' in the specified new value of the environment variable. To
750 include a `$' in the value, use `$$'.
751
752 +++
753 ** Unquoted `$' in file names do not signal an error any more when
754 the corresponding environment variable does not exist.
755 Instead, the `$ENVVAR' text is left as is, so that `$$' quoting
756 is only rarely needed.
757
758 ---
759 ** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
760 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
761 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
762 This change may result in using the different coding systems as
763 default in some locale (e.g. vi_VN).
764
765 +++
766 ** The default for the paper size (variable ps-paper-type) is taken
767 from the locale.
768
769 +++
770 ** The keyboard-coding-system is now automatically set based on your
771 current locale settings if you are not using a window system. This
772 may mean that the META key doesn't work but generates non-ASCII
773 characters instead, depending on how the terminal (or terminal
774 emulator) works. Use `set-keyboard-coding-system' (or customize
775 keyboard-coding-system) if you prefer META to work (the old default)
776 or if the locale doesn't describe the character set actually generated
777 by the keyboard. See Info node `Single-Byte Character Support'.
778
779 +++
780 ** The new command `revert-buffer-with-coding-system' (C-x RET r)
781 revisits the current file using a coding system that you specify.
782
783 +++
784 ** New command `recode-region' decodes the region again by a specified
785 coding system.
786
787 +++
788 ** The new command `recode-file-name' changes the encoding of the name
789 of a file.
790
791 ---
792 ** New command `ucs-insert' inserts a character specified by its
793 unicode.
794
795 +++
796 ** The new command `set-file-name-coding-system' (C-x RET F) sets
797 coding system for encoding and decoding file names. A new menu item
798 (Options->Mule->Set Coding Systems->For File Name) invokes this
799 command.
800
801 +++
802 ** New command quail-show-key shows what key (or key sequence) to type
803 in the current input method to input a character at point.
804
805 +++
806 ** Limited support for character `unification' has been added.
807 Emacs now knows how to translate between different representations of
808 the same characters in various Emacs charsets according to standard
809 Unicode mappings. This applies mainly to characters in the ISO 8859
810 sets plus some other 8-bit sets, but can be extended. For instance,
811 translation works amongst the Emacs ...-iso8859-... charsets and the
812 mule-unicode-... ones.
813
814 By default this translation happens automatically on encoding.
815 Self-inserting characters are translated to make the input conformant
816 with the encoding of the buffer in which it's being used, where
817 possible.
818
819 You can force a more complete unification with the user option
820 unify-8859-on-decoding-mode. That maps all the Latin-N character sets
821 into Unicode characters (from the latin-iso8859-1 and
822 mule-unicode-0100-24ff charsets) on decoding. Note that this mode
823 will often effectively clobber data with an iso-2022 encoding.
824
825 ---
826 ** There is support for decoding Greek and Cyrillic characters into
827 either Unicode (the mule-unicode charsets) or the iso-8859 charsets,
828 when possible. The latter are more space-efficient. This is
829 controlled by user option utf-fragment-on-decoding.
830
831 ---
832 ** New language environments: French, Ukrainian, Tajik,
833 Bulgarian, Belarusian, Ukrainian, UTF-8, Windows-1255, Welsh, Latin-6,
834 Latin-7, Lithuanian, Latvian, Swedish, Slovenian, Croatian, Georgian,
835 Italian, Russian, Malayalam, Tamil, Russian, Chinese-EUC-TW. (Set up
836 automatically according to the locale.)
837
838 ---
839 ** New input methods: latin-alt-postfix, latin-postfix, latin-prefix,
840 ukrainian-computer, belarusian, bulgarian-bds, russian-computer,
841 vietnamese-telex, lithuanian-numeric, lithuanian-keyboard,
842 latvian-keyboard, welsh, georgian, rfc1345, ucs, sgml,
843 bulgarian-phonetic, dutch, slovenian, croatian, malayalam-inscript,
844 tamil-inscript.
845
846 ---
847 ** New input method chinese-sisheng for inputting Chinese Pinyin
848 characters.
849
850 ---
851 ** Improved Thai support. A new minor mode `thai-word-mode' (which is
852 automatically activated if you select Thai as a language
853 environment) changes key bindings of most word-oriented commands to
854 versions which recognize Thai words. Affected commands are
855 M-f (forward-word)
856 M-b (backward-word)
857 M-d (kill-word)
858 M-DEL (backward-kill-word)
859 M-t (transpose-words)
860 M-q (fill-paragraph)
861
862 ---
863 ** Indian support has been updated.
864 The in-is13194 coding system is now Unicode-based. CDAC fonts are
865 assumed. There is a framework for supporting various
866 Indian scripts, but currently only Devanagari, Malayalam and Tamil are
867 supported.
868
869 ---
870 ** A UTF-7 coding system is available in the library `utf-7'.
871
872 ---
873 ** The utf-8/16 coding systems have been enhanced.
874 By default, untranslatable utf-8 sequences are simply composed into
875 single quasi-characters. User option `utf-translate-cjk-mode' (it is
876 turned on by default) arranges to translate many utf-8 CJK character
877 sequences into real Emacs characters in a similar way to the Mule-UCS
878 system. As this loads a fairly big data on demand, people who are not
879 interested in CJK characters may want to customize it to nil.
880 You can augment/amend the CJK translation via hash tables
881 `ucs-mule-cjk-to-unicode' and `ucs-unicode-to-mule-cjk'. The utf-8
882 coding system now also encodes characters from most of Emacs's
883 one-dimensional internal charsets, specifically the ISO-8859 ones.
884 The utf-16 coding system is affected similarly.
885
886 ---
887 ** A new coding system `euc-tw' has been added for traditional Chinese
888 in CNS encoding; it accepts both Big 5 and CNS as input; on saving,
889 Big 5 is then converted to CNS.
890
891 ---
892 ** Many new coding systems are available by loading the `code-pages'
893 library. These include complete versions of most of those in
894 codepage.el, based on Unicode mappings. `codepage-setup' is now
895 obsolete and is used only in the MS-DOS port of Emacs. windows-1252
896 and windows-1251 are preloaded since the former is so common and the
897 latter is used by GNU locales.
898
899 ---
900 ** New variable `utf-translate-cjk-unicode-range' controls which
901 Unicode characters to translate in `utf-translate-cjk-mode'.
902
903 ---
904 ** iso-10646-1 (`Unicode') fonts can be used to display any range of
905 characters encodable by the utf-8 coding system. Just specify the
906 fontset appropriately.
907
908 +++
909 ** Vertical scrolling is now possible within incremental search.
910 To enable this feature, customize the new user option
911 `isearch-allow-scroll'. User written commands which satisfy stringent
912 constraints can be marked as "scrolling commands". See the Emacs manual
913 for details.
914
915 +++
916 ** C-w in incremental search now grabs either a character or a word,
917 making the decision in a heuristic way. This new job is done by the
918 command `isearch-yank-word-or-char'. To restore the old behavior,
919 bind C-w to `isearch-yank-word' in `isearch-mode-map'.
920
921 +++
922 ** C-y in incremental search now grabs the next line if point is already
923 at the end of a line.
924
925 +++
926 ** C-M-w deletes and C-M-y grabs a character in isearch mode.
927 Another method to grab a character is to enter the minibuffer by `M-e'
928 and to type `C-f' at the end of the search string in the minibuffer.
929
930 +++
931 ** M-% typed in isearch mode invokes `query-replace' or
932 `query-replace-regexp' (depending on search mode) with the current
933 search string used as the string to replace.
934
935 +++
936 ** Isearch no longer adds `isearch-resume' commands to the command
937 history by default. To enable this feature, customize the new
938 user option `isearch-resume-in-command-history'.
939
940 ---
941 ** New user option `query-replace-skip-read-only': when non-nil,
942 `query-replace' and related functions simply ignore
943 a match if part of it has a read-only property.
944
945 +++
946 ** When used interactively, the commands `query-replace-regexp' and
947 `replace-regexp' allow \,expr to be used in a replacement string,
948 where expr is an arbitrary Lisp expression evaluated at replacement
949 time. In many cases, this will be more convenient than using
950 `query-replace-regexp-eval'. `\#' in a replacement string now refers
951 to the count of replacements already made by the replacement command.
952 All regular expression replacement commands now allow `\?' in the
953 replacement string to specify a position where the replacement string
954 can be edited for each replacement.
955
956 +++
957 ** query-replace uses isearch lazy highlighting when the new user option
958 `query-replace-lazy-highlight' is non-nil.
959
960 ---
961 ** The current match in query-replace is highlighted in new face
962 `query-replace' which by default inherits from isearch face.
963
964 +++
965 ** M-x compare-windows now can automatically skip non-matching text to
966 resync points in both windows.
967
968 +++
969 ** The commands M-x customize-face and M-x customize-face-other-window
970 now look at the character after point. If a face or faces are
971 specified for that character, the commands by default customize those
972 faces.
973
974 ---
975 ** The face-customization widget has been reworked to be less confusing.
976 In particular, when you enable a face attribute using the corresponding
977 check-box, there's no longer a redundant `*' option in value selection
978 for that attribute; the values you can choose are only those which make
979 sense for the attribute. When an attribute is de-selected by unchecking
980 its check-box, then the (now ignored, but still present temporarily in
981 case you re-select the attribute) value is hidden.
982
983 +++
984 ** When you set or reset a variable's value in a Customize buffer,
985 the previous value becomes the "backup value" of the variable.
986 You can go back to that backup value by selecting "Use Backup Value"
987 under the "[State]" button.
988
989 ** Dired mode:
990
991 ---
992 *** New faces dired-header, dired-mark, dired-marked, dired-flagged,
993 dired-ignored, dired-directory, dired-symlink, dired-warning
994 introduced for Dired mode instead of font-lock faces.
995
996 +++
997 *** New Dired command `dired-compare-directories' marks files
998 with different file attributes in two dired buffers.
999
1000 +++
1001 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1002 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1003
1004 +++
1005 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1006 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1007 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1008 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1009 doublequotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1010 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1011
1012 +++
1013 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name
1014 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names.
1015
1016 +++
1017 ** The variables dired-free-space-program and dired-free-space-args
1018 have been renamed to directory-free-space-program and
1019 directory-free-space-args, and they now apply whenever Emacs puts a
1020 directory listing into a buffer.
1021
1022 +++
1023 ** Dired-x:
1024
1025 +++
1026 *** Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. The mode toggling
1027 command is bound to M-o. A new command dired-mark-omitted, bound to * O,
1028 marks omitted files. The variable dired-omit-files-p is obsoleted, use the
1029 mode toggling function instead.
1030
1031 +++
1032 ** In Outline mode, hide-body no longer hides lines at the top
1033 of the file that precede the first header line.
1034
1035 +++
1036 ** Occur, Info, and comint-derived modes now support using
1037 M-x font-lock-mode to toggle fontification. The variable
1038 `Info-fontify' is no longer applicable; to disable fontification,
1039 remove `turn-on-font-lock' from `Info-mode-hook'.
1040
1041 ---
1042 ** The terminal emulation code in term.el has been improved, it can
1043 run most curses applications now.
1044
1045 ---
1046 ** The comint prompt can now be made read-only, using the new user
1047 option `comint-prompt-read-only'. This is not enabled by default,
1048 except in IELM buffers. The read-only status of IELM prompts can be
1049 controlled with the new user option `ielm-prompt-read-only', which
1050 overrides `comint-prompt-read-only'.
1051
1052 The new commands `comint-kill-whole-line' and `comint-kill-region'
1053 support editing comint buffers with read-only prompts.
1054
1055 `comint-kill-whole-line' is like `kill-whole-line', but ignores both
1056 read-only and field properties. Hence, it always kill entire
1057 lines, including any prompts.
1058
1059 `comint-kill-region' is like `kill-region', except that it ignores
1060 read-only properties, if it is safe to do so. This means that if any
1061 part of a prompt is deleted, then the entire prompt must be deleted
1062 and that all prompts must stay at the beginning of a line. If this is
1063 not the case, then `comint-kill-region' behaves just like
1064 `kill-region' if read-only are involved: it copies the text to the
1065 kill-ring, but does not delete it.
1066
1067 +++
1068 ** The new command `comint-insert-previous-argument' in comint-derived
1069 modes (shell-mode etc) inserts arguments from previous command lines,
1070 like bash's `ESC .' binding. It is bound by default to `C-c .', but
1071 otherwise behaves quite similarly to the bash version.
1072
1073 ** `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields' has been renamed
1074 `comint-use-prompt-regexp'. The old name has been kept as an alias,
1075 but declared obsolete.
1076
1077 +++
1078 ** Telnet now prompts you for a port number with C-u M-x telnet.
1079
1080 ---
1081 ** M-x compile has become more robust and reliable
1082
1083 Quite a few more kinds of messages are recognized. Messages that are
1084 recognized as warnings or informational come in orange or green, instead of
1085 red. Informational messages are by default skipped with `next-error'
1086 (controlled by `compilation-skip-threshold').
1087
1088 Location data is collected on the fly as the *compilation* buffer changes.
1089 This means you could modify messages to make them point to different files.
1090 This also means you can not go to locations of messages you may have deleted.
1091
1092 The variable `compilation-error-regexp-alist' has now become customizable. If
1093 you had added your own regexps to this, you'll probably need to include a
1094 leading `^', otherwise they'll match anywhere on a line. There is now also a
1095 `compilation-mode-font-lock-keywords' and it nicely handles all the checks
1096 that configure outputs and -o options so you see at a glance where you are.
1097
1098 The new file etc/compilation.txt gives examples of each type of message.
1099
1100 ** Compilation mode enhancements:
1101
1102 +++
1103 *** New user option `compilation-environment'.
1104 This option allows you to specify environment variables for inferior
1105 compilation processes without affecting the environment that all
1106 subprocesses inherit.
1107
1108 +++
1109 ** Grep has been decoupled from compilation mode setup.
1110
1111 ---
1112 *** There's a new separate package grep.el.
1113
1114 ---
1115 *** M-x grep has been adapted to new compile
1116
1117 Hits are fontified in green, and hits in binary files in orange. Grep buffers
1118 can be saved and automatically revisited with the new Grep mode.
1119
1120 ---
1121 *** Grep commands now have their own submenu and customization group.
1122
1123 +++
1124 *** `grep-find' is now also available under the name `find-grep' where
1125 people knowing `find-grep-dired' would probably expect it.
1126
1127 ---
1128 *** The new variables `grep-window-height', `grep-auto-highlight', and
1129 `grep-scroll-output' can be used to override the corresponding
1130 compilation mode settings for grep commands.
1131
1132 +++
1133 *** New option `grep-highlight-matches' highlightes matches in *grep*
1134 buffer. It uses a special feature of some grep programs which accept
1135 --color option to output markers around matches. When going to the next
1136 match with `next-error' the exact match is highlighted in the source
1137 buffer. Otherwise, if `grep-highlight-matches' is nil, the whole
1138 source line is highlighted.
1139
1140 +++
1141 *** New key bindings in grep output window:
1142 SPC and DEL scrolls window up and down. C-n and C-p moves to next and
1143 previous match in the grep window. RET jumps to the source line of
1144 the current match. `n' and `p' shows next and previous match in
1145 other window, but does not switch buffer. `{' and `}' jumps to the
1146 previous or next file in the grep output. TAB also jumps to the next
1147 file.
1148
1149 +++
1150 ** M-x grep now tries to avoid appending `/dev/null' to the command line
1151 by using GNU grep `-H' option instead. M-x grep automatically
1152 detects whether this is possible or not the first time it is invoked.
1153 When `-H' is used, the grep command line supplied by the user is passed
1154 unchanged to the system to execute, which allows more complicated
1155 command lines to be used than was possible before.
1156
1157 +++
1158 ** New options `next-error-highlight' and `next-error-highlight-no-select'
1159 specify the method of highlighting of the corresponding source line
1160 in new face `next-error'.
1161
1162 +++
1163 ** A new minor mode `next-error-follow-minor-mode' can be used in
1164 compilation-mode, grep-mode, occur-mode, and diff-mode (i.e. all the
1165 modes that can use `next-error'). In this mode, cursor motion in the
1166 buffer causes automatic display in another window of the corresponding
1167 matches, compilation errors, etc. This minor mode can be toggled with
1168 C-c C-f.
1169
1170 +++
1171 ** M-x diff uses diff-mode instead of compilation-mode.
1172
1173 +++
1174 ** In the *Occur* buffer, `o' switches to it in another window, and
1175 C-o displays the current line's occurrence in another window without
1176 switching to it.
1177
1178 +++
1179 ** You can now use next-error (C-x `) and previous-error to advance to
1180 the next/previous matching line found by M-x occur.
1181
1182 +++
1183 ** The new command `multi-occur' is just like `occur', except it can
1184 search multiple buffers. There is also a new command
1185 `multi-occur-by-filename-regexp' which allows you to specify the
1186 buffers to search by their filename. Internally, Occur mode has been
1187 rewritten, and now uses font-lock, among other changes.
1188
1189 +++
1190 ** font-lock: in modes like C and Lisp where the fontification assumes that
1191 an open-paren in column 0 is always outside of any string or comment,
1192 font-lock now highlights any such open-paren-in-column-zero in bold-red
1193 if it is inside a string or a comment, to indicate that it can cause
1194 trouble with fontification and/or indentation.
1195
1196 ** Enhancements to apropos commands:
1197
1198 +++
1199 *** The apropos commands now accept a list of words to match.
1200 When more than one word is specified, at least two of those words must
1201 be present for an item to match. Regular expression matching is still
1202 available.
1203
1204 +++
1205 *** The new option `apropos-sort-by-scores' causes the matching items
1206 to be sorted according to their score. The score for an item is a
1207 number calculated to indicate how well the item matches the words or
1208 regular expression that you entered to the apropos command. The best
1209 match is listed first, and the calculated score is shown for each
1210 matching item.
1211
1212 +++
1213 ** You can have several Emacs servers on the same machine.
1214
1215 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "foo")' -f server-start &
1216 % emacs --eval '(setq server-name "bar")' -f server-start &
1217 % emacsclient -s foo file1
1218 % emacsclient -s bar file2
1219
1220 +++
1221 ** The `emacsclient' command understands the options `--eval' and
1222 `--display' which tell Emacs respectively to evaluate the given elisp
1223 expression and to use the given display when visiting files.
1224
1225 +++
1226 ** User option `server-mode' can be used to start a server process.
1227
1228 +++
1229 ** New user option `add-log-always-start-new-record'.
1230 When this option is enabled, M-x add-change-log-entry always
1231 starts a new record regardless of when the last record is.
1232
1233 ** Info mode:
1234
1235 +++
1236 *** A numeric prefix argument of `info' selects an Info buffer
1237 with the number appended to the *info* buffer name (e.g. "*info*<2>").
1238
1239 ---
1240 *** isearch in Info uses Info-search and searches through multiple nodes.
1241 Before leaving the initial Info node isearch fails once with the error
1242 message [initial node], and with subsequent C-s/C-r continues through
1243 other nodes. When isearch fails for the rest of the manual, it wraps
1244 aroung the whole manual to the top/final node. The user option
1245 `Info-isearch-search' controls whether to use Info-search for isearch,
1246 or the default isearch search function that wraps around the current
1247 Info node.
1248
1249 *** New search commands: `Info-search-case-sensitively' (bound to S),
1250 `Info-search-backward', and `Info-search-next' which repeats the last
1251 search without prompting for a new search string.
1252
1253 *** New command `Info-history-forward' (bound to r and new toolbar icon)
1254 moves forward in history to the node you returned from after using
1255 `Info-history-back' (renamed from `Info-last').
1256
1257 *** New command `Info-history' (bound to L) displays a menu of visited nodes.
1258
1259 *** New command `Info-toc' (bound to T) creates a node with table of contents
1260 from the tree structure of menus of the current Info file.
1261
1262 *** New command `info-apropos' searches the indices of the known
1263 Info files on your system for a string, and builds a menu of the
1264 possible matches.
1265
1266 *** New command `Info-copy-current-node-name' (bound to w) copies
1267 the current Info node name into the kill ring. With a zero prefix
1268 arg, puts the node name inside the `info' function call.
1269
1270 ---
1271 *** New face `info-xref-visited' distinguishes visited nodes from unvisited
1272 and a new option `Info-fontify-visited-nodes' to control this.
1273
1274 *** http and ftp links in Info are now operational: they look like cross
1275 references and following them calls `browse-url'.
1276
1277 +++
1278 *** Info now hides node names in menus and cross references by default.
1279 If you prefer the old behavior, you can set the new user option
1280 `Info-hide-note-references' to nil.
1281
1282 ---
1283 *** Images in Info pages are supported.
1284 Info pages show embedded images, in Emacs frames with image support.
1285 Info documentation that includes images, processed with makeinfo
1286 version 4.7 or newer, compiles to Info pages with embedded images.
1287
1288 +++
1289 *** The default value for `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' is now nil.
1290
1291 ---
1292 *** Info-index offers completion.
1293
1294 ---
1295 ** Lisp mode now uses font-lock-doc-face for the docstrings.
1296
1297 +++
1298 ** A prefix argument of C-M-q in Emacs Lisp mode pretty-printifies the
1299 list starting after point.
1300
1301 ** New features in evaluation commands
1302
1303 +++
1304 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) called on defface reinitializes
1305 the face to the value specified in the defface expression.
1306
1307 +++
1308 *** Typing C-x C-e twice prints the value of the integer result
1309 in additional formats (octal, hexadecimal, character) specified
1310 by the new function `eval-expression-print-format'. The same
1311 function also defines the result format for `eval-expression' (M-:),
1312 `eval-print-last-sexp' (C-j) and some edebug evaluation functions.
1313
1314 +++
1315 ** CC Mode changes.
1316
1317 *** Font lock support.
1318 CC Mode now provides font lock support for all its languages. This
1319 supersedes the font lock patterns that have been in the core font lock
1320 package for C, C++, Java and Objective-C. Like indentation, font
1321 locking is done in a uniform way across all languages (except the new
1322 AWK mode - see below). That means that the new font locking will be
1323 different from the old patterns in various details for most languages.
1324
1325 The main goal of the font locking in CC Mode is accuracy, to provide a
1326 dependable aid in recognizing the various constructs. Some, like
1327 strings and comments, are easy to recognize while others like
1328 declarations and types can be very tricky. CC Mode can go to great
1329 lengths to recognize declarations and casts correctly, especially when
1330 the types aren't recognized by standard patterns. This is a fairly
1331 demanding analysis which can be slow on older hardware, and it can
1332 therefore be disabled by choosing a lower decoration level with the
1333 variable font-lock-maximum-decoration.
1334
1335 Note that the most demanding font lock level has been tuned with lazy
1336 fontification in mind, i.e. there should be a support mode that waits
1337 with the fontification until the text is actually shown
1338 (e.g. Just-in-time Lock mode, which is the default, or Lazy Lock
1339 mode). Fontifying a file with several thousand lines in one go can
1340 take the better part of a minute.
1341
1342 **** The (c|c++|objc|java|idl|pike)-font-lock-extra-types variables
1343 are now used by CC Mode to recognize identifiers that are certain to
1344 be types. (They are also used in cases that aren't related to font
1345 locking.) At the maximum decoration level, types are often recognized
1346 properly anyway, so these variables should be fairly restrictive and
1347 not contain patterns for uncertain types.
1348
1349 **** Support for documentation comments.
1350 There is a "plugin" system to fontify documentation comments like
1351 Javadoc and the markup within them. It's independent of the host
1352 language, so it's possible to e.g. turn on Javadoc font locking in C
1353 buffers. See the variable c-doc-comment-style for details.
1354
1355 Currently two kinds of doc comment styles are recognized: Suns Javadoc
1356 and Autodoc which is used in Pike. This is by no means a complete
1357 list of the most common tools; if your doc comment extractor of choice
1358 is missing then please drop a note to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1359
1360 **** Better handling of C++ templates.
1361 As a side effect of the more accurate font locking, C++ templates are
1362 now handled much better. The angle brackets that delimit them are
1363 given parenthesis syntax so that they can be navigated like other
1364 parens.
1365
1366 This also improves indentation of templates, although there still is
1367 work to be done in that area. E.g. it's required that multiline
1368 template clauses are written in full and then refontified to be
1369 recognized, and the indentation of nested templates is a bit odd and
1370 not as configurable as it ought to be.
1371
1372 **** Improved handling of Objective-C and CORBA IDL.
1373 Especially the support for Objective-C and IDL has gotten an overhaul.
1374 The special "@" declarations in Objective-C are handled correctly.
1375 All the keywords used in CORBA IDL, PSDL, and CIDL are recognized and
1376 handled correctly, also wrt indentation.
1377
1378 *** Support for the AWK language.
1379 Support for the AWK language has been introduced. The implementation is
1380 based around GNU AWK version 3.1, but it should work pretty well with
1381 any AWK. As yet, not all features of CC Mode have been adapted for AWK.
1382 Here is a summary:
1383
1384 **** Indentation Engine
1385 The CC Mode indentation engine fully supports AWK mode.
1386
1387 AWK mode handles code formatted in the conventional AWK fashion: `{'s
1388 which start actions, user-defined functions, or compound statements are
1389 placed on the same line as the associated construct; the matching `}'s
1390 are normally placed under the start of the respective pattern, function
1391 definition, or structured statement.
1392
1393 The predefined indentation functions haven't yet been adapted for AWK
1394 mode, though some of them may work serendipitously. There shouldn't be
1395 any problems writing custom indentation functions for AWK mode.
1396
1397 The command C-c C-q (c-indent-defun) hasn't yet been adapted for AWK,
1398 though in practice it works properly nearly all the time. Should it
1399 fail, explicitly set the region around the function (using C-u C-SPC:
1400 C-M-h probably won't work either) then do C-M-\ (indent-region).
1401
1402 **** Font Locking
1403 There is a single level of font locking in AWK mode, rather than the
1404 three distinct levels the other modes have. There are several
1405 idiosyncrasies in AWK mode's font-locking due to the peculiarities of
1406 the AWK language itself.
1407
1408 **** Comment Commands
1409 M-; (indent-for-comment) works fine. None of the other CC Mode
1410 comment formatting commands have yet been adapted for AWK mode.
1411
1412 **** Movement Commands
1413 Most of the movement commands work in AWK mode. The most important
1414 exceptions are M-a (c-beginning-of-statement) and M-e
1415 (c-end-of-statement) which haven't yet been adapted.
1416
1417 The notion of "defun" has been augmented to include AWK pattern-action
1418 pairs. C-M-a (c-awk-beginning-of-defun) and C-M-e (c-awk-end-of-defun)
1419 recognise these pattern-action pairs, as well as user defined
1420 functions.
1421
1422 **** Auto-newline Insertion and Clean-ups
1423 Auto-newline insertion hasn't yet been adapted for AWK. Some of
1424 the clean-ups can actually convert good AWK code into syntactically
1425 invalid code. These features are best disabled in AWK buffers.
1426
1427 *** New syntactic symbols in IDL mode.
1428 The top level constructs "module" and "composition" (from CIDL) are
1429 now handled like "namespace" in C++: They are given syntactic symbols
1430 module-open, module-close, inmodule, composition-open,
1431 composition-close, and incomposition.
1432
1433 *** New functions to do hungry delete without enabling hungry delete mode.
1434 The functions c-hungry-backspace and c-hungry-delete-forward can be
1435 bound to keys to get this feature without toggling a mode.
1436 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1437
1438 *** Better control over require-final-newline. The variable that
1439 controls how to handle a final newline when the buffer is saved,
1440 require-final-newline, is now customizable on a per-mode basis through
1441 c-require-final-newline. That is a list of modes, and only those
1442 modes set require-final-newline. By default that's C, C++ and
1443 Objective-C.
1444
1445 The specified modes set require-final-newline based on
1446 mode-require-final-newline, as usual.
1447
1448 *** Format change for syntactic context elements.
1449 The elements in the syntactic context returned by c-guess-basic-syntax
1450 and stored in c-syntactic-context has been changed somewhat to allow
1451 attaching more information. They are now lists instead of single cons
1452 cells. E.g. a line that previously had the syntactic analysis
1453
1454 ((inclass . 11) (topmost-intro . 13))
1455
1456 is now analysed as
1457
1458 ((inclass 11) (topmost-intro 13))
1459
1460 In some cases there are more than one position given for a syntactic
1461 symbol.
1462
1463 This change might affect code that call c-guess-basic-syntax directly,
1464 and custom lineup functions if they use c-syntactic-context. However,
1465 the argument given to lineup functions is still a single cons cell
1466 with nil or an integer in the cdr.
1467
1468 *** API changes for derived modes.
1469 There have been extensive changes "under the hood" which can affect
1470 derived mode writers. Some of these changes are likely to cause
1471 incompatibilities with existing derived modes, but on the other hand
1472 care has now been taken to make it possible to extend and modify CC
1473 Mode with less risk of such problems in the future.
1474
1475 **** New language variable system.
1476 See the comment blurb near the top of cc-langs.el.
1477
1478 **** New initialization functions.
1479 The initialization procedure has been split up into more functions to
1480 give better control: c-basic-common-init, c-font-lock-init, and
1481 c-init-language-vars.
1482
1483 *** Changes in analysis of nested syntactic constructs.
1484 The syntactic analysis engine has better handling of cases where
1485 several syntactic constructs appear nested on the same line. They are
1486 now handled as if each construct started on a line of its own.
1487
1488 This means that CC Mode now indents some cases differently, and
1489 although it's more consistent there might be cases where the old way
1490 gave results that's more to one's liking. So if you find a situation
1491 where you think that the indentation has become worse, please report
1492 it to bug-cc-mode@gnu.org.
1493
1494 **** New syntactic symbol substatement-label.
1495 This symbol is used when a label is inserted between a statement and
1496 its substatement. E.g:
1497
1498 if (x)
1499 x_is_true:
1500 do_stuff();
1501
1502 *** Better handling of multiline macros.
1503
1504 **** Syntactic indentation inside macros.
1505 The contents of multiline #define's are now analyzed and indented
1506 syntactically just like other code. This can be disabled by the new
1507 variable c-syntactic-indentation-in-macros. A new syntactic symbol
1508 cpp-define-intro has been added to control the initial indentation
1509 inside #define's.
1510
1511 **** New lineup function c-lineup-cpp-define.
1512 Now used by default to line up macro continuation lines. The behavior
1513 of this function closely mimics the indentation one gets if the macro
1514 is indented while the line continuation backslashes are temporarily
1515 removed. If syntactic indentation in macros is turned off, it works
1516 much line c-lineup-dont-change, which was used earlier, but handles
1517 empty lines within the macro better.
1518
1519 **** Automatically inserted newlines continues the macro if used within one.
1520 This applies to the newlines inserted by the auto-newline mode, and to
1521 c-context-line-break and c-context-open-line.
1522
1523 **** Better alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1524 c-backslash-region tries to adapt to surrounding backslashes. New
1525 variable c-backslash-max-column which put a limit on how far out
1526 backslashes can be moved.
1527
1528 **** Automatic alignment of line continuation backslashes.
1529 This is controlled by the new variable c-auto-align-backslashes. It
1530 affects c-context-line-break, c-context-open-line and newlines
1531 inserted in auto-newline mode.
1532
1533 **** Line indentation works better inside macros.
1534 Regardless whether syntactic indentation and syntactic indentation
1535 inside macros are enabled or not, line indentation now ignores the
1536 line continuation backslashes. This is most noticeable when syntactic
1537 indentation is turned off and there are empty lines (save for the
1538 backslash) in the macro.
1539
1540 *** indent-for-comment is more customizable.
1541 The behavior of M-; (indent-for-comment) is now configurable through
1542 the variable c-indent-comment-alist. The indentation behavior based
1543 on the preceding code on the line, e.g. to get two spaces after #else
1544 and #endif but indentation to comment-column in most other cases
1545 (something which was hardcoded earlier).
1546
1547 *** New function c-context-open-line.
1548 It's the open-line equivalent of c-context-line-break.
1549
1550 *** New lineup functions
1551
1552 **** c-lineup-string-cont
1553 This lineup function lines up a continued string under the one it
1554 continues. E.g:
1555
1556 result = prefix + "A message "
1557 "string."; <- c-lineup-string-cont
1558
1559 **** c-lineup-cascaded-calls
1560 Lines up series of calls separated by "->" or ".".
1561
1562 **** c-lineup-knr-region-comment
1563 Gives (what most people think is) better indentation of comments in
1564 the "K&R region" between the function header and its body.
1565
1566 **** c-lineup-gcc-asm-reg
1567 Provides better indentation inside asm blocks. Contributed by Kevin
1568 Ryde.
1569
1570 **** c-lineup-argcont
1571 Lines up continued function arguments after the preceding comma.
1572 Contributed by Kevin Ryde.
1573
1574 *** Better caching of the syntactic context.
1575 CC Mode caches the positions of the opening parentheses (of any kind)
1576 of the lists surrounding the point. Those positions are used in many
1577 places as anchor points for various searches. The cache is now
1578 improved so that it can be reused to a large extent when the point is
1579 moved. The less it moves, the less needs to be recalculated.
1580
1581 The effect is that CC Mode should be fast most of the time even when
1582 opening parens are hung (i.e. aren't in column zero). It's typically
1583 only the first time after the point is moved far down in a complex
1584 file that it'll take noticeable time to find out the syntactic
1585 context.
1586
1587 *** Statements are recognized in a more robust way.
1588 Statements are recognized most of the time even when they occur in an
1589 "invalid" context, e.g. in a function argument. In practice that can
1590 happen when macros are involved.
1591
1592 *** Improved the way c-indent-exp chooses the block to indent.
1593 It now indents the block for the closest sexp following the point
1594 whose closing paren ends on a different line. This means that the
1595 point doesn't have to be immediately before the block to indent.
1596 Also, only the block and the closing line is indented; the current
1597 line is left untouched.
1598
1599 *** Added toggle for syntactic indentation.
1600 The function c-toggle-syntactic-indentation can be used to toggle
1601 syntactic indentation.
1602
1603 ---
1604 ** Perl mode has a new variable `perl-indent-continued-arguments'.
1605
1606 ---
1607 ** Fortran mode does more font-locking by default. Use level 3
1608 highlighting for the old default.
1609
1610 +++
1611 ** Fortran mode has a new variable `fortran-directive-re'.
1612 Adapt this to match the format of any compiler directives you use.
1613 Lines that match are never indented, and are given distinctive font-locking.
1614
1615 +++
1616 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have new navigation commands
1617 `f90-end-of-block', `f90-beginning-of-block', `f90-next-block',
1618 `f90-previous-block', `fortran-end-of-block',
1619 `fortran-beginning-of-block'.
1620
1621 ---
1622 ** F90 mode and Fortran mode have support for hs-minor-mode (hideshow).
1623 It cannot deal with every code format, but ought to handle a sizeable
1624 majority.
1625
1626 ---
1627 ** The new function `f90-backslash-not-special' can be used to change
1628 the syntax of backslashes in F90 buffers.
1629
1630 ---
1631 ** Prolog mode has a new variable `prolog-font-lock-keywords'
1632 to support use of font-lock.
1633
1634 ---
1635 ** Emacs now tries to set up buffer coding systems for HTML/XML files
1636 automatically.
1637
1638 +++
1639 ** SGML mode has indentation and supports XML syntax.
1640 The new variable `sgml-xml-mode' tells SGML mode to use XML syntax.
1641 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
1642 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
1643 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
1644 from the file name or buffer contents.
1645
1646 +++
1647 ** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
1648
1649 ** TeX modes:
1650
1651 +++
1652 *** C-c C-c prompts for a command to run, and tries to offer a good default.
1653
1654 +++
1655 *** The user option `tex-start-options-string' has been replaced
1656 by two new user options: `tex-start-options', which should hold
1657 command-line options to feed to TeX, and `tex-start-commands' which should hold
1658 TeX commands to use at startup.
1659
1660 ---
1661 *** verbatim environments are now highlighted in courier by font-lock
1662 and super/sub-scripts are made into super/sub-scripts.
1663
1664 +++
1665 *** New major mode doctex-mode for *.dtx files.
1666
1667 ** BibTeX mode:
1668 *** The new command bibtex-url browses a URL for the BibTeX entry at
1669 point (bound to C-c C-l and mouse-2, RET on clickable fields).
1670
1671 *** The new command bibtex-entry-update (bound to C-c C-u) updates
1672 an existing BibTeX entry.
1673
1674 *** New `bibtex-entry-format' option `required-fields', enabled by default.
1675
1676 *** bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries can take values `plain',
1677 `crossref', and `entry-class' which control the sorting scheme used
1678 for BibTeX entries. `bibtex-sort-entry-class' controls the sorting
1679 scheme `entry-class'. TAB completion for reference keys and
1680 automatic detection of duplicates does not require anymore that
1681 bibtex-maintain-sorted-entries is non-nil.
1682
1683 *** If the new variable bibtex-parse-keys-fast is non-nil,
1684 use fast but simplified algorithm for parsing BibTeX keys.
1685
1686 *** If the new variable bibtex-autoadd-commas is non-nil,
1687 automatically add missing commas at end of BibTeX fields.
1688
1689 *** The new variable bibtex-autofill-types contains a list of entry
1690 types for which fields are filled automatically (if possible).
1691
1692 *** The new command bibtex-complete completes word fragment before
1693 point according to context (bound to M-tab).
1694
1695 *** The new commands bibtex-find-entry and bibtex-find-crossref
1696 locate entries and crossref'd entries (bound to C-c C-s and C-c C-x).
1697 Crossref fields are clickable (bound to mouse-2, RET).
1698
1699 *** In BibTeX mode the command fill-paragraph (bound to M-q) fills
1700 individual fields of a BibTeX entry.
1701
1702 *** The new variables bibtex-files and bibtex-file-path define a set
1703 of BibTeX files that are searched for entry keys.
1704
1705 *** The new command bibtex-validate-globally checks for duplicate keys
1706 in multiple BibTeX files.
1707
1708 *** The new command bibtex-copy-summary-as-kill pushes summary
1709 of BibTeX entry to kill ring (bound to C-c C-t).
1710
1711 +++
1712 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
1713 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
1714 and `C-c C-r'.
1715
1716 +++
1717 ** In GUD mode, when talking to GDB, C-x C-a C-j "jumps" the program
1718 counter to the specified source line (the one where point is).
1719
1720 ---
1721 ** GUD mode has its own tool bar for controlling execution of the inferior
1722 and other common debugger commands.
1723
1724 ---
1725 ** GUD mode improvements for jdb:
1726
1727 *** Search for source files using jdb classpath and class
1728 information. Fast startup since there is no need to scan all
1729 source files up front. There is also no need to create and maintain
1730 lists of source directories to scan. Look at `gud-jdb-use-classpath'
1731 and `gud-jdb-classpath' customization variables documentation.
1732
1733 *** Supports the standard breakpoint (gud-break, gud-clear)
1734 set/clear operations from java source files under the classpath, stack
1735 traversal (gud-up, gud-down), and run until current stack finish
1736 (gud-finish).
1737
1738 *** Supports new jdb (Java 1.2 and later) in addition to oldjdb
1739 (Java 1.1 jdb).
1740
1741 *** The previous method of searching for source files has been
1742 preserved in case someone still wants/needs to use it.
1743 Set gud-jdb-use-classpath to nil.
1744
1745 Added Customization Variables
1746
1747 *** gud-jdb-command-name. What command line to use to invoke jdb.
1748
1749 *** gud-jdb-use-classpath. Allows selection of java source file searching
1750 method: set to t for new method, nil to scan gud-jdb-directories for
1751 java sources (previous method).
1752
1753 *** gud-jdb-directories. List of directories to scan and search for java
1754 classes using the original gud-jdb method (if gud-jdb-use-classpath
1755 is nil).
1756
1757 Minor Improvements
1758
1759 *** The STARTTLS elisp wrapper (starttls.el) can now use GNUTLS
1760 instead of the OpenSSL based "starttls" tool. For backwards
1761 compatibility, it prefers "starttls", but you can toggle
1762 `starttls-use-gnutls' to switch to GNUTLS (or simply remove the
1763 "starttls" tool).
1764
1765 *** Do not allow debugger output history variable to grow without bounds.
1766
1767 +++
1768 ** You can now use Auto Revert mode to `tail' a file.
1769 If point is at the end of a file buffer before reverting, Auto Revert
1770 mode keeps it at the end after reverting. Similarly if point is
1771 displayed at the end of a file buffer in any window, it stays at
1772 the end of the buffer in that window. This allows to tail a file:
1773 just put point at the end of the buffer and it stays there. This
1774 rule applies to file buffers. For non-file buffers, the behavior may
1775 be mode dependent.
1776
1777 If you are sure that the file will only change by growing at the end,
1778 then you can tail the file more efficiently by using the new minor
1779 mode Auto Revert Tail mode. The function `auto-revert-tail-mode'
1780 toggles this mode.
1781
1782 +++
1783 ** Auto Revert mode is now more careful to avoid excessive reverts and
1784 other potential problems when deciding which non-file buffers to
1785 revert. This matters especially if Global Auto Revert mode is enabled
1786 and `global-auto-revert-non-file-buffers' is non-nil. Auto Revert
1787 mode only reverts a non-file buffer if the buffer has a non-nil
1788 `revert-buffer-function' and a non-nil `buffer-stale-function', which
1789 decides whether the buffer should be reverted. Currently, this means
1790 that auto reverting works for Dired buffers (although this may not
1791 work properly on all operating systems) and for the Buffer Menu.
1792
1793 +++
1794 ** If the new user option `auto-revert-check-vc-info' is non-nil, Auto
1795 Revert mode reliably updates version control info (such as the version
1796 control number in the mode line), in all version controlled buffers in
1797 which it is active. If the option is nil, the default, then this info
1798 only gets updated whenever the buffer gets reverted.
1799
1800 ---
1801 ** recentf changes.
1802
1803 The recent file list is now automatically cleanup when recentf mode is
1804 enabled. The new option `recentf-auto-cleanup' controls when to do
1805 automatic cleanup.
1806
1807 The `recentf-keep' option replaces `recentf-keep-non-readable-files-p'
1808 and provides a more general mechanism to customize which file names to
1809 keep in the recent list.
1810
1811 With the more advanced option: `recentf-filename-handler', you can
1812 specify a function that transforms filenames handled by recentf. For
1813 example, if set to `file-truename', the same file will not be in the
1814 recent list with different symbolic links.
1815
1816 To follow naming convention, `recentf-menu-append-commands-flag'
1817 replaces the misnamed option `recentf-menu-append-commands-p'. The
1818 old name remains available as alias, but has been marked obsolete.
1819
1820 +++
1821 ** Desktop package
1822
1823 +++
1824 *** Desktop saving is now a minor mode, desktop-save-mode. Variable
1825 desktop-enable is obsolete. Customize desktop-save-mode to enable desktop
1826 saving.
1827
1828 ---
1829 *** Buffers are saved in the desktop file in the same order as that in the
1830 buffer list.
1831
1832 +++
1833 *** The desktop package can be customized to restore only some buffers immediately,
1834 remaining buffers are restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
1835
1836 +++
1837 *** New commands:
1838 - desktop-revert reverts to the last loaded desktop.
1839 - desktop-change-dir kills current desktop and loads a new.
1840 - desktop-save-in-desktop-dir saves desktop in the directory from which
1841 it was loaded.
1842 - desktop-lazy-complete runs the desktop load to completion.
1843 - desktop-lazy-abort aborts lazy loading of the desktop.
1844
1845 ---
1846 *** New customizable variables:
1847 - desktop-save. Determins whether the desktop should be saved when it is
1848 killed.
1849 - desktop-file-name-format. Format in which desktop file names should be saved.
1850 - desktop-path. List of directories in which to lookup the desktop file.
1851 - desktop-locals-to-save. List of local variables to save.
1852 - desktop-globals-to-clear. List of global variables that `desktop-clear' will clear.
1853 - desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp. Regexp identifying buffers that `desktop-clear'
1854 should not delete.
1855 - desktop-restore-eager. Number of buffers to restore immediately. Remaining buffers are
1856 restored lazily (when Emacs is idle).
1857 - desktop-lazy-verbose. Verbose reporting of lazily created buffers.
1858 - desktop-lazy-idle-delay. Idle delay before starting to create buffers.
1859
1860 +++
1861 *** New command line option --no-desktop
1862
1863 ---
1864 *** New hooks:
1865 - desktop-after-read-hook run after a desktop is loaded.
1866 - desktop-no-desktop-file-hook run when no desktop file is found.
1867
1868 ---
1869 ** The saveplace.el package now filters out unreadable files.
1870 When you exit Emacs, the saved positions in visited files no longer
1871 include files that aren't readable, e.g. files that don't exist.
1872 Customize the new option `save-place-forget-unreadable-files' to nil
1873 to get the old behavior. The new options `save-place-save-skipped'
1874 and `save-place-skip-check-regexp' allow further fine-tuning of this
1875 feature.
1876
1877 ** EDiff changes.
1878
1879 +++
1880 *** When comparing directories.
1881 Typing D brings up a buffer that lists the differences between the contents of
1882 directories. Now it is possible to use this buffer to copy the missing files
1883 from one directory to another.
1884
1885 +++
1886 *** When comparing files or buffers.
1887 Typing the = key now offers to perform the word-by-word comparison of the
1888 currently highlighted regions in an inferior Ediff session. If you answer 'n'
1889 then it reverts to the old behavior and asks the user to select regions for
1890 comparison.
1891
1892 *** The new command `ediff-backup' compares a file with its most recent
1893 backup using `ediff'. If you specify the name of a backup file,
1894 `ediff-backup' compares it with the file of which it is a backup.
1895
1896 +++
1897 ** Etags changes.
1898
1899 *** New regular expressions features
1900
1901 **** New syntax for regular expressions, multi-line regular expressions.
1902 The syntax --ignore-case-regexp=/regex/ is now undocumented and retained
1903 only for backward compatibility. The new equivalent syntax is
1904 --regex=/regex/i. More generally, it is --regex=/TAGREGEX/TAGNAME/MODS,
1905 where `/TAGNAME' is optional, as usual, and MODS is a string of 0 or
1906 more characters among `i' (ignore case), `m' (multi-line) and `s'
1907 (single-line). The `m' and `s' modifiers behave as in Perl regular
1908 expressions: `m' allows regexps to match more than one line, while `s'
1909 (which implies `m') means that `.' matches newlines. The ability to
1910 span newlines allows writing of much more powerful regular expressions
1911 and rapid prototyping for tagging new languages.
1912
1913 **** Regular expressions can use char escape sequences as in Gcc.
1914 The escaped character sequence \a, \b, \d, \e, \f, \n, \r, \t, \v,
1915 respectively, stand for the ASCII characters BEL, BS, DEL, ESC, FF, NL,
1916 CR, TAB, VT,
1917
1918 **** Regular expressions can be bound to a given language.
1919 The syntax --regex={LANGUAGE}REGEX means that REGEX is used to make tags
1920 only for files of language LANGUAGE, and ignored otherwise. This is
1921 particularly useful when storing regexps in a file.
1922
1923 **** Regular expressions can be read from a file.
1924 The --regex=@regexfile option means read the regexps from a file, one
1925 per line. Lines beginning with space or tab are ignored.
1926
1927 *** New language parsing features
1928
1929 **** The `::' qualifier triggers C++ parsing in C file.
1930 Previously, only the `template' and `class' keywords had this effect.
1931
1932 **** The gnucc __attribute__ keyword is now recognised and ignored.
1933
1934 **** New language HTML.
1935 Title and h1, h2, h3 are tagged. Also, tags are generated when name= is
1936 used inside an anchor and whenever id= is used.
1937
1938 **** In Makefiles, constants are tagged.
1939 If you want the old behavior instead, thus avoiding to increase the
1940 size of the tags file, use the --no-globals option.
1941
1942 **** New language Lua.
1943 All functions are tagged.
1944
1945 **** In Perl, packages are tags.
1946 Subroutine tags are named from their package. You can jump to sub tags
1947 as you did before, by the sub name, or additionally by looking for
1948 package::sub.
1949
1950 **** In Prolog, etags creates tags for rules in addition to predicates.
1951
1952 **** New language PHP.
1953 Tags are functions, classes and defines.
1954 If the --members option is specified to etags, tags are variables also.
1955
1956 **** New default keywords for TeX.
1957 The new keywords are def, newcommand, renewcommand, newenvironment and
1958 renewenvironment.
1959
1960 *** Honour #line directives.
1961 When Etags parses an input file that contains C preprocessor's #line
1962 directives, it creates tags using the file name and line number
1963 specified in those directives. This is useful when dealing with code
1964 created from Cweb source files. When Etags tags the generated file, it
1965 writes tags pointing to the source file.
1966
1967 *** New option --parse-stdin=FILE.
1968 This option is mostly useful when calling etags from programs. It can
1969 be used (only once) in place of a file name on the command line. Etags
1970 reads from standard input and marks the produced tags as belonging to
1971 the file FILE.
1972
1973 ** VC Changes
1974
1975 +++
1976 *** The key C-x C-q no longer checks files in or out, it only changes
1977 the read-only state of the buffer (toggle-read-only). We made this
1978 change because we held a poll and found that many users were unhappy
1979 with the previous behavior. If you do prefer this behavior, you
1980 can bind `vc-toggle-read-only' to C-x C-q in your .emacs:
1981
1982 (global-set-key "\C-x\C-q" 'vc-toggle-read-only)
1983
1984 The function `vc-toggle-read-only' will continue to exist.
1985
1986 +++
1987 *** There is a new user option `vc-cvs-global-switches' that allows
1988 you to specify switches that are passed to any CVS command invoked
1989 by VC. These switches are used as "global options" for CVS, which
1990 means they are inserted before the command name. For example, this
1991 allows you to specify a compression level using the "-z#" option for
1992 CVS.
1993
1994 +++
1995 *** New backends for Subversion and Meta-CVS.
1996
1997 +++
1998 ** vc-annotate-mode enhancements
1999
2000 In vc-annotate mode, you can now use the following key bindings for
2001 enhanced functionality to browse the annotations of past revisions, or
2002 to view diffs or log entries directly from vc-annotate-mode:
2003
2004 P: annotates the previous revision
2005 N: annotates the next revision
2006 J: annotates the revision at line
2007 A: annotates the revision previous to line
2008 D: shows the diff of the revision at line with its previous revision
2009 L: shows the log of the revision at line
2010 W: annotates the workfile (most up to date) version
2011
2012 +++
2013 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d y' command to view the diffs
2014 between the local version of the file and yesterday's head revision
2015 in the repository.
2016
2017 +++
2018 ** In pcl-cvs mode, there is a new `d r' command to view the changes
2019 anyone has committed to the repository since you last executed
2020 "checkout", "update" or "commit". That means using cvs diff options
2021 -rBASE -rHEAD.
2022
2023 +++
2024 ** There is a new user option `mail-default-directory' that allows you
2025 to specify the value of `default-directory' for mail buffers. This
2026 directory is used for auto-save files of mail buffers. It defaults to
2027 "~/".
2028
2029 +++
2030 ** Emacs can now indicate in the mode-line the presence of new e-mail
2031 in a directory or in a file. See the documentation of the user option
2032 `display-time-mail-directory'.
2033
2034 ---
2035 ** PO translation files are decoded according to their MIME headers
2036 when Emacs visits them.
2037
2038 ** Gnus package
2039
2040 ---
2041 *** Gnus now includes Sieve and PGG
2042 Sieve is a library for managing Sieve scripts. PGG is a library to handle
2043 PGP/MIME.
2044
2045 ---
2046 *** There are many news features, bug fixes and improvements.
2047 See the file GNUS-NEWS or the node "Oort Gnus" in the Gnus manual for details.
2048
2049 ---
2050 ** Rmail now displays 5-digit message ids in its summary buffer.
2051
2052 +++
2053 ** Support for `movemail' from GNU mailutils was added to Rmail.
2054 This version of `movemail' allows to read mail from a wide range of
2055 mailbox formats, including remote POP3 and IMAP4 mailboxes with or
2056 without TLS encryption. If GNU mailutils is installed on the system
2057 and its version of `movemail' can be found in exec-path, it will be
2058 used instead of the native one.
2059
2060 ---
2061 ** MH-E changes.
2062
2063 Upgraded to MH-E version 7.82. There have been major changes since
2064 version 5.0.2; see MH-E-NEWS for details.
2065
2066 +++
2067 ** There is a new calendar package, icalendar.el, that can be used to
2068 convert Emacs diary entries to/from the iCalendar format.
2069
2070 +++
2071 ** Diary sexp entries can have custom marking in the calendar.
2072 Diary sexp functions which only apply to certain days (such as
2073 `diary-block' or `diary-cyclic') now take an optional parameter MARK,
2074 which is the name of a face or a single-character string indicating
2075 how to highlight the day in the calendar display. Specifying a
2076 single-character string as @var{mark} places the character next to the
2077 day in the calendar. Specifying a face highlights the day with that
2078 face. This lets you have different colors or markings for vacations,
2079 appointments, paydays or anything else using a sexp.
2080
2081 +++
2082 ** The new function `calendar-goto-day-of-year' (g D) prompts for a
2083 year and day number, and moves to that date. Negative day numbers
2084 count backward from the end of the year.
2085
2086 +++
2087 ** The new Calendar function `calendar-goto-iso-week' (g w)
2088 prompts for a year and a week number, and moves to the first
2089 day of that ISO week.
2090
2091 ---
2092 ** The new variable `calendar-minimum-window-height' affects the
2093 window generated by the function `generate-calendar-window'.
2094
2095 ---
2096 ** The functions `holiday-easter-etc' and `holiday-advent' now take
2097 optional arguments, in order to only report on the specified holiday
2098 rather than all. This makes customization of variables such as
2099 `christian-holidays' simpler.
2100
2101 ---
2102 ** The function `simple-diary-display' now by default sets a header line.
2103 This can be controlled through the variables `diary-header-line-flag'
2104 and `diary-header-line-format'.
2105
2106 +++
2107 ** The procedure for activating appointment reminders has changed: use
2108 the new function `appt-activate'. The new variable
2109 `appt-display-format' controls how reminders are displayed, replacing
2110 appt-issue-message, appt-visible, and appt-msg-window.
2111
2112 +++
2113 ** The new functions `diary-from-outlook', `diary-from-outlook-gnus',
2114 and `diary-from-outlook-rmail' can be used to import diary entries
2115 from Outlook-format appointments in mail messages. The variable
2116 `diary-outlook-formats' can be customized to recognize additional
2117 formats.
2118
2119 +++
2120 ** Emacs now supports drag and drop for X. Dropping a file on a window
2121 opens it, dropping text inserts the text. Dropping a file on a dired
2122 buffer copies or moves the file to that directory.
2123
2124 +++
2125 ** Under X11, it is possible to swap Alt and Meta (and Super and Hyper).
2126 The new variables `x-alt-keysym', `x-hyper-keysym', `x-meta-keysym',
2127 and `x-super-keysym' can be used to choose which keysyms Emacs should
2128 use for the modifiers. For example, the following two lines swap
2129 Meta and Alt:
2130 (setq x-alt-keysym 'meta)
2131 (setq x-meta-keysym 'alt)
2132
2133 +++
2134 ** The X resource useXIM can be used to turn off use of XIM, which may
2135 speed up Emacs with slow networking to the X server.
2136
2137 If the configure option `--without-xim' was used to turn off use of
2138 XIM by default, the X resource useXIM can be used to turn it on.
2139
2140 ---
2141 ** The new variable `x-select-request-type' controls how Emacs
2142 requests X selection. The default value is nil, which means that
2143 Emacs requests X selection with types COMPOUND_TEXT and UTF8_STRING,
2144 and use the more appropriately result.
2145
2146 ---
2147 ** The scrollbar under LessTif or Motif has a smoother drag-scrolling.
2148 On the other hand, the size of the thumb does not represent the actual
2149 amount of text shown any more (only a crude approximation of it).
2150
2151 ---
2152 ** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
2153 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
2154
2155 +++
2156 ** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
2157 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
2158 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
2159
2160 ---
2161 ** Dialogs for Lucid/Athena and Lesstif/Motif now pops down when pressing
2162 ESC, like they do for Gtk+, Mac and W32.
2163
2164 ---
2165 ** Dialogs and menus pop down if you type C-g.
2166
2167 ---
2168 ** The menu item "Open File..." has been split into two items, "New File..."
2169 and "Open File...". "Open File..." now opens only existing files. This is
2170 to support existing GUI file selection dialogs better.
2171
2172 +++
2173 ** The file selection dialog for Gtk+, Mac, W32 and Motif/Lesstif can be
2174 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
2175
2176 +++
2177 ** For Gtk+ version 2.4, you can make Emacs use the old file dialog
2178 by setting the variable `x-use-old-gtk-file-dialog' to t. Default is to use
2179 the new dialog.
2180
2181 ---
2182 ** Emacs now responds to mouse-clicks on the mode-line, header-line and
2183 display margin, when run in an xterm.
2184
2185 ** Improved key bindings support when running in an xterm.
2186 When emacs is running in an xterm more key bindings are available. The
2187 following should work:
2188 {C,S,C-S,A}-{right,left,up,down,prior,next,delete,insert,F1-12}.
2189 These key bindings work on xterm from X.org 6.8, they might not work on
2190 some older versions of xterm, or on some proprietary versions.
2191
2192 ** Changes in support of colors on character terminals
2193
2194 +++
2195 *** The new command-line option --color=MODE lets you specify a standard
2196 mode for a tty color support. It is meant to be used on character
2197 terminals whose capabilities are not set correctly in the terminal
2198 database, or with terminal emulators which support colors, but don't
2199 set the TERM environment variable to a name of a color-capable
2200 terminal. "emacs --color" uses the same color commands as GNU `ls'
2201 when invoked with "ls --color", so if your terminal can support colors
2202 in "ls --color", it will support "emacs --color" as well. See the
2203 user manual for the possible values of the MODE parameter.
2204
2205 ---
2206 *** Emacs now supports several character terminals which provide more
2207 than 8 colors. For example, for `xterm', 16-color, 88-color, and
2208 256-color modes are supported. Emacs automatically notes at startup
2209 the extended number of colors, and defines the appropriate entries for
2210 all of these colors.
2211
2212 +++
2213 *** Emacs now uses the full range of available colors for the default
2214 faces when running on a color terminal, including 16-, 88-, and
2215 256-color xterms. This means that when you run "emacs -nw" on an
2216 88-color or 256-color xterm, you will see essentially the same face
2217 colors as on X.
2218
2219 ---
2220 *** There's a new support for colors on `rxvt' terminal emulator.
2221
2222 +++
2223 ** Passing resources on the command line now works on MS Windows.
2224 You can use --xrm to pass resource settings to Emacs, overriding any
2225 existing values. For example:
2226
2227 emacs --xrm "Emacs.Background:red" --xrm "Emacs.Geometry:100x20"
2228
2229 will start up Emacs on an initial frame of 100x20 with red background,
2230 irrespective of geometry or background setting on the Windows registry.
2231
2232 ---
2233 ** On MS Windows, the "system caret" now follows the cursor.
2234 This enables Emacs to work better with programs that need to track
2235 the cursor, for example screen magnifiers and text to speech programs.
2236
2237 ---
2238 ** Tooltips now work on MS Windows.
2239 See the Emacs 21.1 NEWS entry for tooltips for details.
2240
2241 ---
2242 ** Images are now supported on MS Windows.
2243 PBM and XBM images are supported out of the box. Other image formats
2244 depend on external libraries. All of these libraries have been ported
2245 to Windows, and can be found in both source and binary form at
2246 http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net/. Note that libpng also depends on
2247 zlib, and tiff depends on the version of jpeg that it was compiled
2248 against. For additional information, see nt/INSTALL.
2249
2250 ---
2251 ** Sound is now supported on MS Windows.
2252 WAV format is supported on all versions of Windows, other formats such
2253 as AU, AIFF and MP3 may be supported in the more recent versions of
2254 Windows, or when other software provides hooks into the system level
2255 sound support for those formats.
2256
2257 ---
2258 ** Different shaped mouse pointers are supported on MS Windows.
2259 The mouse pointer changes shape depending on what is under the pointer.
2260
2261 ---
2262 ** Pointing devices with more than 3 buttons are now supported on MS Windows.
2263 The new variable `w32-pass-extra-mouse-buttons-to-system' controls
2264 whether Emacs should handle the extra buttons itself (the default), or
2265 pass them to Windows to be handled with system-wide functions.
2266
2267 ---
2268 ** Emacs takes note of colors defined in Control Panel on MS-Windows.
2269 The Control Panel defines some default colors for applications in much
2270 the same way as wildcard X Resources do on X. Emacs now adds these
2271 colors to the colormap prefixed by System (eg SystemMenu for the
2272 default Menu background, SystemMenuText for the foreground), and uses
2273 some of them to initialize some of the default faces.
2274 `list-colors-display' shows the list of System color names, in case
2275 you wish to use them in other faces.
2276
2277 ---
2278 ** On MS Windows NT/W2K/XP, Emacs uses Unicode for clipboard operations.
2279 Those systems use Unicode internally, so this allows Emacs to share
2280 multilingual text with other applications. On other versions of
2281 MS Windows, Emacs now uses the appropriate locale coding-system, so
2282 the clipboard should work correctly for your local language without
2283 any customizations.
2284
2285 ---
2286 ** On Mac OS, the value of the variable `keyboard-coding-system' is
2287 now dynamically changed according to the current keyboard script. The
2288 variable `mac-keyboard-text-encoding' and the constants
2289 `kTextEncodingMacRoman', `kTextEncodingISOLatin1', and
2290 `kTextEncodingISOLatin2' are obsolete.
2291
2292 ---
2293 ** sql changes.
2294
2295 *** The variable `sql-product' controls the highlightng of different
2296 SQL dialects. This variable can be set globally via Customize, on a
2297 buffer-specific basis via local variable settings, or for the current
2298 session using the new SQL->Product submenu. (This menu replaces the
2299 SQL->Highlighting submenu.)
2300
2301 The following values are supported:
2302
2303 ansi ANSI Standard (default)
2304 db2 DB2
2305 informix Informix
2306 ingres Ingres
2307 interbase Interbase
2308 linter Linter
2309 ms Microsoft
2310 mysql MySQL
2311 oracle Oracle
2312 postgres Postgres
2313 solid Solid
2314 sqlite SQLite
2315 sybase Sybase
2316
2317 The current product name will be shown on the mode line following the
2318 SQL mode indicator.
2319
2320 The technique of setting `sql-mode-font-lock-defaults' directly in
2321 your .emacs will no longer establish the default highlighting -- Use
2322 `sql-product' to accomplish this.
2323
2324 ANSI keywords are always highlighted.
2325
2326 *** The function `sql-add-product-keywords' can be used to add
2327 font-lock rules to the product specific rules. For example, to have
2328 all identifiers ending in "_t" under MS SQLServer treated as a type,
2329 you would use the following line in your .emacs file:
2330
2331 (sql-add-product-keywords 'ms
2332 '(("\\<\\w+_t\\>" . font-lock-type-face)))
2333
2334 *** Oracle support includes keyword highlighting for Oracle 9i. Most
2335 SQL and PL/SQL keywords are implemented. SQL*Plus commands are
2336 highlighted in `font-lock-doc-face'.
2337
2338 *** Microsoft SQLServer support has been significantly improved.
2339 Keyword highlighting for SqlServer 2000 is implemented.
2340 sql-interactive-mode defaults to use osql, rather than isql, because
2341 osql flushes its error stream more frequently. Thus error messages
2342 are displayed when they occur rather than when the session is
2343 terminated.
2344
2345 If the username and password are not provided to `sql-ms', osql is
2346 called with the -E command line argument to use the operating system
2347 credentials to authenticate the user.
2348
2349 *** Postgres support is enhanced.
2350 Keyword highlighting of Postgres 7.3 is implemented. Prompting for
2351 the username and the pgsql `-U' option is added.
2352
2353 *** MySQL support is enhanced.
2354 Keyword higlighting of MySql 4.0 is implemented.
2355
2356 *** Imenu support has been enhanced to locate tables, views, indexes,
2357 packages, procedures, functions, triggers, sequences, rules, and
2358 defaults.
2359
2360 *** Added SQL->Start SQLi Session menu entry which calls the
2361 appropriate sql-interactive-mode wrapper for the current setting of
2362 `sql-product'.
2363
2364 ---
2365 *** Support for the SQLite interpreter has been added to sql.el by calling
2366 'sql-sqlite'.
2367
2368 ---
2369 ** M-x view-file and commands that use it now avoid interfering
2370 with special modes such as Tar mode.
2371
2372 +++
2373 ** Filesets are collections of files. You can define a fileset in
2374 various ways, such as based on a directory tree or based on
2375 program files that include other program files.
2376
2377 Once you have defined a fileset, you can perform various operations on
2378 all the files in it, such as visiting them or searching and replacing
2379 in them.
2380
2381 ---
2382 ** Commands winner-redo and winner-undo, from winner.el, are now bound to
2383 C-c <left> and C-c <right>, respectively. This is an incompatible change.
2384
2385 ** FFAP
2386
2387 +++
2388 *** New ffap commands and keybindings: C-x C-r (`ffap-read-only'),
2389 C-x C-v (`ffap-alternate-file'), C-x C-d (`ffap-list-directory'),
2390 C-x 4 r (`ffap-read-only-other-window'), C-x 4 d (`ffap-dired-other-window'),
2391 C-x 5 r (`ffap-read-only-other-frame'), C-x 5 d (`ffap-dired-other-frame').
2392
2393 ---
2394 *** FFAP accepts wildcards in a file name by default. C-x C-f passes
2395 it to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS argument, which visits
2396 multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
2397
2398 ---
2399 ** skeleton.el now supports using - to mark the skeleton-point without
2400 interregion interaction. @ has reverted to only setting
2401 skeleton-positions and no longer sets skeleton-point. Skeletons
2402 which used @ to mark skeleton-point independent of _ should now use -
2403 instead. The updated skeleton-insert docstring explains these new
2404 features along with other details of skeleton construction.
2405
2406 ---
2407 ** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
2408 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
2409 handles the overlay property `display' specially, preserving it during
2410 temporary overlay showing in the course of an isearch operation.
2411
2412 +++
2413 ** hide-ifdef-mode now uses overlays rather than selective-display
2414 to hide its text. This should be mostly transparent but slightly
2415 changes the behavior of motion commands like C-e and C-p.
2416
2417 ---
2418 ** partial-completion-mode now does partial completion on directory names.
2419
2420 ---
2421 ** The type-break package now allows `type-break-file-name' to be nil
2422 and if so, doesn't store any data across sessions. This is handy if
2423 you don't want the .type-break file in your home directory or are
2424 annoyed by the need for interaction when you kill Emacs.
2425
2426 ---
2427 ** `ps-print' can now print characters from the mule-unicode charsets.
2428
2429 Printing text with characters from the mule-unicode-* sets works with
2430 ps-print, provided that you have installed the appropriate BDF fonts.
2431 See the file INSTALL for URLs where you can find these fonts.
2432
2433 ---
2434 ** New command `strokes-global-set-stroke-string'.
2435 This is like `strokes-global-set-stroke', but it allows you to bind
2436 the stroke directly to a string to insert. This is convenient for
2437 using strokes as an input method.
2438
2439 ---
2440 ** LDAP support now defaults to ldapsearch from OpenLDAP version 2.
2441
2442 +++
2443 ** You can now disable pc-selection-mode after enabling it.
2444 M-x pc-selection-mode behaves like a proper minor mode, and with no
2445 argument it toggles the mode.
2446
2447 Turning off PC-Selection mode restores the global key bindings
2448 that were replaced by turning on the mode.
2449
2450 ---
2451 ** `uniquify-strip-common-suffix' tells uniquify to prefer
2452 `file|dir1' and `file|dir2' to `file|dir1/subdir' and `file|dir2/subdir'.
2453
2454 ---
2455 ** rx.el has new corresponding `symbol-end' and `symbol-start' elements.
2456
2457 ---
2458 ** Support for `magic cookie' standout modes has been removed.
2459 Emacs will still work on terminals that require magic cookies in order
2460 to use standout mode, however they will not be able to display
2461 mode-lines in inverse-video.
2462
2463 ---
2464 ** The game `mpuz' is enhanced.
2465
2466 `mpuz' now allows the 2nd factor not to have two identical digits. By
2467 default, all trivial operations involving whole lines are performed
2468 automatically. The game uses faces for better visual feedback.
2469
2470 ---
2471 ** display-battery has been replaced by display-battery-mode.
2472
2473 ---
2474 ** calculator.el now has radix grouping mode, which is available when
2475 `calculator-output-radix' is non-nil. In this mode a separator
2476 character is used every few digits, making it easier to see byte
2477 boundries etc. For more info, see the documentation of the variable
2478 `calculator-radix-grouping-mode'.
2479
2480 ---
2481 ** global-whitespace-mode is a new alias for whitespace-global-mode.
2482
2483 +++
2484 ** The command `list-text-properties-at' has been deleted because
2485 C-u C-x = gives the same information and more.
2486
2487 ---
2488 ** fast-lock.el and lazy-lock.el are obsolete. Use jit-lock.el instead.
2489
2490 ---
2491 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
2492
2493 ---
2494 ** cplus-md.el has been removed to avoid problems with Custom.
2495
2496 \f
2497 * New modes and packages in Emacs 22.1
2498
2499 +++
2500 ** New package benchmark.el contains simple support for convenient
2501 timing measurements of code (including the garbage collection component).
2502
2503 +++
2504 ** Calc is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2505
2506 Calc is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool written in
2507 Emacs Lisp. Its documentation is in a separate manual; within Emacs,
2508 type "C-h i m calc RET" to read that manual. A reference card is
2509 available in `etc/calccard.tex' and `etc/calccard.ps'.
2510
2511 ---
2512 ** `cfengine-mode' is a major mode for editing GNU Cfengine
2513 configuration files.
2514
2515 +++
2516 ** The new package conf-mode.el handles thousands of configuration files, with
2517 varying syntaxes for comments (;, #, //, /* */ or !), assignment (var = value,
2518 var : value, var value or keyword var value) and sections ([section] or
2519 section { }). Many files under /etc/, or with suffixes like .cf through
2520 .config, .properties (Java), .desktop (KDE/Gnome), .ini and many others are
2521 recognized.
2522
2523 ---
2524 ** CUA mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2525
2526 The new cua package provides CUA-like keybindings using C-x for
2527 cut (kill), C-c for copy, C-v for paste (yank), and C-z for undo.
2528 With cua, the region can be set and extended using shifted movement
2529 keys (like pc-selection-mode) and typed text replaces the active
2530 region (like delete-selection-mode). Do not enable these modes with
2531 cua-mode. Customize the variable `cua-mode' to enable cua.
2532
2533 In addition, cua provides unified rectangle support with visible
2534 rectangle highlighting: Use S-return to start a rectangle, extend it
2535 using the movement commands (or mouse-3), and cut or copy it using C-x
2536 or C-c (using C-w and M-w also works).
2537
2538 Use M-o and M-c to `open' or `close' the rectangle, use M-b or M-f, to
2539 fill it with blanks or another character, use M-u or M-l to upcase or
2540 downcase the rectangle, use M-i to increment the numbers in the
2541 rectangle, use M-n to fill the rectangle with a numeric sequence (such
2542 as 10 20 30...), use M-r to replace a regexp in the rectangle, and use
2543 M-' or M-/ to restrict command on the rectangle to a subset of the
2544 rows. See the commentary in cua-base.el for more rectangle commands.
2545
2546 Cua also provides unified support for registers: Use a numeric
2547 prefix argument between 0 and 9, i.e. M-0 .. M-9, for C-x, C-c, and
2548 C-v to cut or copy into register 0-9, or paste from register 0-9.
2549
2550 The last text deleted (not killed) is automatically stored in
2551 register 0. This includes text deleted by typing text.
2552
2553 Finally, cua provides a global mark which is set using S-C-space.
2554 When the global mark is active, any text which is cut or copied is
2555 automatically inserted at the global mark position. See the
2556 commentary in cua-base.el for more global mark related commands.
2557
2558 The features of cua also works with the standard emacs bindings for
2559 kill, copy, yank, and undo. If you want to use cua mode, but don't
2560 want the C-x, C-c, C-v, and C-z bindings, you may customize the
2561 `cua-enable-cua-keys' variable.
2562
2563 Note: This version of cua mode is not backwards compatible with older
2564 versions of cua.el and cua-mode.el. To ensure proper operation, you
2565 must remove older versions of cua.el or cua-mode.el as well as the
2566 loading and customization of those packages from the .emacs file.
2567
2568 +++
2569 ** The new package dns-mode.el add syntax highlight of DNS master files.
2570 The key binding C-c C-s (`dns-mode-soa-increment-serial') can be used
2571 to increment the SOA serial.
2572
2573 ---
2574 ** The new global minor mode `file-name-shadow-mode' modifies the way
2575 filenames being entered by the user in the minibuffer are displayed, so
2576 that it's clear when part of the entered filename will be ignored due to
2577 emacs' filename parsing rules. The ignored portion can be made dim,
2578 invisible, or otherwise less visually noticable. The display method may
2579 be displayed by customizing the variable `file-name-shadow-properties'.
2580
2581 +++
2582 ** The new package flymake.el does on-the-fly syntax checking of program
2583 source files. See the Flymake's Info manual for more details.
2584
2585 ---
2586 ** The new Lisp library fringe.el controls the appearance of fringes.
2587
2588 ---
2589 ** GDB-Script-mode is used for files like .gdbinit.
2590
2591 +++
2592 ** The new package gdb-ui.el provides an enhanced graphical interface to
2593 GDB. You can interact with GDB through the GUD buffer in the usual way, but
2594 there are also further buffers which control the execution and describe the
2595 state of your program. It separates the input/output of your program from
2596 that of GDB and watches expressions in the speedbar. It also uses features of
2597 Emacs 21 such as the display margin for breakpoints, and the toolbar.
2598
2599 Use M-x gdba to start GDB-UI.
2600
2601 ---
2602 ** The new package ibuffer provides a powerful, completely
2603 customizable replacement for buff-menu.el.
2604
2605 ---
2606 ** Ido mode is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2607
2608 The ido (interactively do) package is an extension of the iswitchb
2609 package to do interactive opening of files and directories in addition
2610 to interactive buffer switching. Ido is a superset of iswitchb (with
2611 a few exceptions), so don't enable both packages.
2612
2613 +++
2614 ** Image files are normally visited in Image mode, which lets you toggle
2615 between viewing the image and viewing the text using C-c C-c.
2616
2617 +++
2618 ** The new keypad setup package provides several common bindings for
2619 the numeric keypad which is available on most keyboards. The numeric
2620 keypad typically has the digits 0 to 9, a decimal point, keys marked
2621 +, -, /, and *, an Enter key, and a NumLock toggle key. The keypad
2622 package only controls the use of the digit and decimal keys.
2623
2624 By customizing the variables `keypad-setup', `keypad-shifted-setup',
2625 `keypad-numlock-setup', and `keypad-numlock-shifted-setup', or by
2626 using the function `keypad-setup', you can rebind all digit keys and
2627 the decimal key of the keypad in one step for each of the four
2628 possible combinations of the Shift key state (not pressed/pressed) and
2629 the NumLock toggle state (off/on).
2630
2631 The choices for the keypad keys in each of the above states are:
2632 `Plain numeric keypad' where the keys generates plain digits,
2633 `Numeric keypad with decimal key' where the character produced by the
2634 decimal key can be customized individually (for internationalization),
2635 `Numeric Prefix Arg' where the keypad keys produce numeric prefix args
2636 for emacs editing commands, `Cursor keys' and `Shifted Cursor keys'
2637 where the keys work like (shifted) arrow keys, home/end, etc., and
2638 `Unspecified/User-defined' where the keypad keys (kp-0, kp-1, etc.)
2639 are left unspecified and can be bound individually through the global
2640 or local keymaps.
2641
2642 +++
2643 ** The new kmacro package provides a simpler user interface to
2644 emacs' keyboard macro facilities.
2645
2646 Basically, it uses two function keys (default F3 and F4) like this:
2647 F3 starts a macro, F4 ends the macro, and pressing F4 again executes
2648 the last macro. While defining the macro, F3 inserts a counter value
2649 which automatically increments every time the macro is executed.
2650
2651 There is now a keyboard macro ring which stores the most recently
2652 defined macros.
2653
2654 The C-x C-k sequence is now a prefix for the kmacro keymap which
2655 defines bindings for moving through the keyboard macro ring,
2656 C-x C-k C-p and C-x C-k C-n, editing the last macro C-x C-k C-e,
2657 manipulating the macro counter and format via C-x C-k C-c,
2658 C-x C-k C-a, and C-x C-k C-f. See the commentary in kmacro.el
2659 for more commands.
2660
2661 The normal macro bindings C-x (, C-x ), and C-x e now interfaces to
2662 the keyboard macro ring.
2663
2664 The C-x e command now automatically terminates the current macro
2665 before calling it, if used while defining a macro.
2666
2667 In addition, when ending or calling a macro with C-x e, the macro can
2668 be repeated immediately by typing just the `e'. You can customize
2669 this behavior via the variable kmacro-call-repeat-key and
2670 kmacro-call-repeat-with-arg.
2671
2672 Keyboard macros can now be debugged and edited interactively.
2673 C-x C-k SPC steps through the last keyboard macro one key sequence
2674 at a time, prompting for the actions to take.
2675
2676 +++
2677 ** The new package longlines.el provides a minor mode for editing text
2678 files composed of long lines, based on the `use-hard-newlines'
2679 mechanism. The long lines are broken up by inserting soft newlines,
2680 which are automatically removed when saving the file to disk or
2681 copying into the kill ring, clipboard, etc. By default, Longlines
2682 mode inserts soft newlines automatically during editing, a behavior
2683 referred to as "soft word wrap" in other text editors. This is
2684 similar to Refill mode, but more reliable. To turn the word wrap
2685 feature off, set `longlines-auto-wrap' to nil.
2686
2687 ---
2688 ** The old Octave mode bindings C-c f and C-c i have been changed
2689 to C-c C-f and C-c C-i. The C-c C-i subcommands now have duplicate
2690 bindings on control characters--thus, C-c C-i C-b is the same as
2691 C-c C-i b, and so on.
2692
2693 ** The printing package is now part of the Emacs distribution.
2694
2695 If you enable the printing package by including (require 'printing) in
2696 the .emacs file, the normal Print item on the File menu is replaced
2697 with a Print sub-menu which allows you to preview output through
2698 ghostview, use ghostscript to print (if you don't have a PostScript
2699 printer) or send directly to printer a PostScript code generated by
2700 `ps-print' package. Use M-x pr-help for more information.
2701
2702 +++
2703 ** The new python.el package is used to edit Python and Jython programs.
2704
2705 ---
2706 ** The minor mode Reveal mode makes text visible on the fly as you
2707 move your cursor into hidden regions of the buffer.
2708 It should work with any package that uses overlays to hide parts
2709 of a buffer, such as outline-minor-mode, hs-minor-mode, hide-ifdef-mode, ...
2710
2711 There is also Global Reveal mode which affects all buffers.
2712
2713 ---
2714 ** The ruler-mode.el library provides a minor mode for displaying an
2715 "active" ruler in the header line. You can use the mouse to visually
2716 change the `fill-column', `window-margins' and `tab-stop-list'
2717 settings.
2718
2719 +++
2720 ** SES mode (ses-mode) is a new major mode for creating and editing
2721 spreadsheet files. Besides the usual Emacs features (intuitive command
2722 letters, undo, cell formulas in Lisp, plaintext files, etc.) it also offers
2723 viral immunity and import/export of tab-separated values.
2724
2725 +++
2726 ** The new global minor mode `size-indication-mode' (off by default)
2727 shows the size of accessible part of the buffer on the mode line.
2728
2729 +++
2730 ** The new package table.el implements editable, WYSIWYG, embedded
2731 `text tables' in Emacs buffers. It simulates the effect of putting
2732 these tables in a special major mode. The package emulates WYSIWYG
2733 table editing available in modern word processors. The package also
2734 can generate a table source in typesetting and markup languages such
2735 as latex and html from the visually laid out text table.
2736
2737 +++
2738 ** The thumbs.el package allows you to preview image files as thumbnails
2739 and can be invoked from a Dired buffer.
2740
2741 +++
2742 ** Tramp is now part of the distribution.
2743
2744 This package is similar to Ange-FTP: it allows you to edit remote
2745 files. But whereas Ange-FTP uses FTP to access the remote host,
2746 Tramp uses a shell connection. The shell connection is always used
2747 for filename completion and directory listings and suchlike, but for
2748 the actual file transfer, you can choose between the so-called
2749 `inline' methods (which transfer the files through the shell
2750 connection using base64 or uu encoding) and the `out-of-band' methods
2751 (which invoke an external copying program such as `rcp' or `scp' or
2752 `rsync' to do the copying).
2753
2754 Shell connections can be acquired via `rsh', `ssh', `telnet' and also
2755 `su' and `sudo'. Ange-FTP is still supported via the `ftp' method.
2756
2757 If you want to disable Tramp you should set
2758
2759 (setq tramp-default-method "ftp")
2760
2761 ---
2762 ** The library tree-widget.el provides a new widget to display a set
2763 of hierarchical data as an outline. For example, the tree-widget is
2764 well suited to display a hierarchy of directories and files.
2765
2766 ---
2767 ** The URL package (which had been part of W3) is now part of Emacs.
2768
2769 ---
2770 ** New minor mode, Visible mode, toggles invisibility in the current buffer.
2771 When enabled, it makes all invisible text visible. When disabled, it
2772 restores the previous value of `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
2773
2774 +++
2775 ** The wdired.el package allows you to use normal editing commands on Dired
2776 buffers to change filenames, permissions, etc...
2777
2778 \f
2779 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2780
2781 +++
2782 ** The new interactive-specification `G' reads a file name
2783 much like `F', but if the input is a directory name (even defaulted),
2784 it returns just the directory name.
2785
2786 +++
2787 ** `suppress-keymap' now works by remapping `self-insert-command' to
2788 the command `undefined'. (In earlier Emacs versions, it used
2789 `substitute-key-definition' to rebind self inserting characters to
2790 `undefined'.)
2791
2792 +++
2793 ** Mode line display ignores text properties as well as the
2794 :propertize and :eval forms in the value of a variable whose
2795 `risky-local-variable' property is nil.
2796 \f
2797 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
2798
2799 +++
2800 ** The option --script FILE runs Emacs in batch mode and loads FILE.
2801 It is useful for writing Emacs Lisp shell script files, because they
2802 can start with this line:
2803
2804 #!/usr/bin/emacs --script
2805
2806 +++
2807 ** The option --directory DIR now modifies `load-path' immediately.
2808 Directories are added to the front of `load-path' in the order they
2809 appear on the command line. For example, with this command line:
2810
2811 emacs -batch -L .. -L /tmp --eval "(require 'foo)"
2812
2813 Emacs looks for library `foo' in the parent directory, then in /tmp, then
2814 in the other directories in `load-path'. (-L is short for --directory.)
2815
2816 +++
2817 ** The default value of `sentence-end' is now defined using the new
2818 variable `sentence-end-without-space', which contains such characters
2819 that end a sentence without following spaces.
2820
2821 The function `sentence-end' should be used to obtain the value of the
2822 variable `sentence-end'. If the variable `sentence-end' is nil, then
2823 this function returns the regexp constructed from the variables
2824 `sentence-end-without-period', `sentence-end-double-space' and
2825 `sentence-end-without-space'.
2826
2827 +++
2828 ** The argument to forward-word, backward-word, forward-to-indentation
2829 and backward-to-indentation is now optional, and defaults to 1.
2830
2831 +++
2832 ** If a command sets transient-mark-mode to `only', that
2833 enables Transient Mark mode for the following command only.
2834 During that following command, the value of transient-mark-mode
2835 is `identity'. If it is still `identity' at the end of the command,
2836 it changes to nil.
2837
2838 +++
2839 ** The new hook `before-save-hook' is invoked by `basic-save-buffer'
2840 before saving buffers. This allows packages to perform various final
2841 tasks, for example; it can be used by the copyright package to make
2842 sure saved files have the current year in any copyright headers.
2843
2844 +++
2845 ** If a buffer sets buffer-save-without-query to non-nil,
2846 save-some-buffers will always save that buffer without asking
2847 (if it's modified).
2848
2849 ---
2850 ** list-buffers-noselect now takes an additional argument, BUFFER-LIST.
2851 If it is non-nil, it specifies which buffers to list.
2852
2853 +++
2854 ** The kill-buffer-hook is now permanent-local.
2855
2856 +++
2857 ** `auto-save-file-format' has been renamed to
2858 `buffer-auto-save-file-format' and made into a permanent local.
2859
2860 +++
2861 ** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
2862 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
2863 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
2864
2865 +++
2866 ** copy-file now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
2867
2868 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
2869
2870 +++
2871 ** If the second argument to `copy-file' is the name of a directory,
2872 the file is copied to that directory instead of signaling an error.
2873
2874 +++
2875 ** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
2876 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
2877
2878 +++
2879 ** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
2880 specifies the maximum number of links to chase through. If after that
2881 many iterations the file name obtained is still a symbolic link,
2882 `file-chase-links' returns it anyway.
2883
2884 +++
2885 ** The function `commandp' takes an additional optional
2886 argument. If it is non-nil, then `commandp' checks
2887 for a function that could be called with `call-interactively',
2888 and does not return t for keyboard macros.
2889
2890 +++
2891 ** An interactive specification may now use the code letter 'U' to get
2892 the up-event that was discarded in case the last key sequence read for a
2893 previous 'k' or 'K' argument was a down-event; otherwise nil is used.
2894
2895 ---
2896 ** Functions y-or-n-p, read-char, read-key-sequence and the like, that
2897 display a prompt but don't use the minibuffer, now display the prompt
2898 using the text properties (esp. the face) of the prompt string.
2899
2900 +++
2901 ** read-from-minibuffer now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
2902 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
2903
2904 +++
2905 ** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
2906 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satify. The
2907 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
2908 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
2909 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
2910
2911 ---
2912 ** The new variable `read-file-name-function' can be used by lisp code
2913 to override the internal read-file-name function.
2914
2915 +++
2916 ** The new variable `read-file-name-completion-ignore-case' specifies
2917 whether completion ignores case when reading a file name with the
2918 `read-file-name' function.
2919
2920 +++
2921 ** The new function `read-directory-name' can be used instead of
2922 `read-file-name' to read a directory name; when used, completion
2923 will only show directories.
2924
2925 +++
2926 ** The new variable search-spaces-regexp controls how to search
2927 for spaces in a regular expression. If it is non-nil, it should be a
2928 regular expression, and any series of spaces stands for that regular
2929 expression. If it is nil, spaces stand for themselves.
2930
2931 Spaces inside of constructs such as [..] and *, +, ? are never
2932 replaced with search-spaces-regexp.
2933
2934 +++
2935 ** There are now two new regular expression operators, \_< and \_>,
2936 for matching the beginning and end of a symbol. A symbol is a
2937 non-empty sequence of either word or symbol constituent characters, as
2938 specified by the syntax table.
2939
2940 +++
2941 ** skip-chars-forward and skip-chars-backward now handle
2942 character classes such as [:alpha:], along with individual characters
2943 and ranges.
2944
2945 ---
2946 ** In `replace-match', the replacement text no longer inherits
2947 properties from surrounding text.
2948
2949 +++
2950 ** The list returned by `(match-data t)' now has the buffer as a final
2951 element, if the last match was on a buffer. `set-match-data'
2952 accepts such a list for restoring the match state.
2953
2954 +++
2955 ** Variable aliases have been implemented:
2956
2957 *** defvaralias ALIAS-VAR BASE-VAR [DOCSTRING]
2958
2959 This function defines the symbol ALIAS-VAR as a variable alias for
2960 symbol BASE-VAR. This means that retrieving the value of ALIAS-VAR
2961 returns the value of BASE-VAR, and changing the value of ALIAS-VAR
2962 changes the value of BASE-VAR.
2963
2964 DOCSTRING, if present, is the documentation for ALIAS-VAR; else it has
2965 the same documentation as BASE-VAR.
2966
2967 *** indirect-variable VARIABLE
2968
2969 This function returns the variable at the end of the chain of aliases
2970 of VARIABLE. If VARIABLE is not a symbol, or if VARIABLE is not
2971 defined as an alias, the function returns VARIABLE.
2972
2973 It might be noteworthy that variables aliases work for all kinds of
2974 variables, including buffer-local and frame-local variables.
2975
2976 +++
2977 *** The macro define-obsolete-variable-alias combines defvaralias and
2978 make-obsolete-variable. The macro define-obsolete-function-alias
2979 combines defalias and make-obsolete.
2980
2981 +++
2982 ** Enhancements to keymaps.
2983
2984 *** Cleaner way to enter key sequences.
2985
2986 You can enter a constant key sequence in a more natural format, the
2987 same one used for saving keyboard macros, using the macro `kbd'. For
2988 example,
2989
2990 (kbd "C-x C-f") => "\^x\^f"
2991
2992 *** Interactive commands can be remapped through keymaps.
2993
2994 This is an alternative to using defadvice or substitute-key-definition
2995 to modify the behavior of a key binding using the normal keymap
2996 binding and lookup functionality.
2997
2998 When a key sequence is bound to a command, and that command is
2999 remapped to another command, that command is run instead of the
3000 original command.
3001
3002 Example:
3003 Suppose that minor mode my-mode has defined the commands
3004 my-kill-line and my-kill-word, and it wants C-k (and any other key
3005 bound to kill-line) to run the command my-kill-line instead of
3006 kill-line, and likewise it wants to run my-kill-word instead of
3007 kill-word.
3008
3009 Instead of rebinding C-k and the other keys in the minor mode map,
3010 command remapping allows you to directly map kill-line into
3011 my-kill-line and kill-word into my-kill-word through the minor mode
3012 map using define-key:
3013
3014 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-line] 'my-kill-line)
3015 (define-key my-mode-map [remap kill-word] 'my-kill-word)
3016
3017 Now, when my-mode is enabled, and the user enters C-k or M-d,
3018 the commands my-kill-line and my-kill-word are run.
3019
3020 Notice that only one level of remapping is supported. In the above
3021 example, this means that if my-kill-line is remapped to other-kill,
3022 then C-k still runs my-kill-line.
3023
3024 The following changes have been made to provide command remapping:
3025
3026 - Command remappings are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
3027 `remap', i.e. `(define-key MAP [remap CMD] DEF)' remaps command CMD
3028 to definition DEF in keymap MAP. The definition is not limited to
3029 another command; it can be anything accepted for a normal binding.
3030
3031 - The new function `command-remapping' returns the binding for a
3032 remapped command in the current keymaps, or nil if not remapped.
3033
3034 - key-binding now remaps interactive commands unless the optional
3035 third argument NO-REMAP is non-nil.
3036
3037 - where-is-internal now returns nil for a remapped command (e.g.
3038 kill-line if my-mode is enabled), and the actual key binding for
3039 the command it is remapped to (e.g. C-k for my-kill-line).
3040 It also has a new optional fifth argument, NO-REMAP, which inhibits
3041 remapping if non-nil (e.g. it returns C-k for kill-line and
3042 <kill-line> for my-kill-line).
3043
3044 - The new variable `this-original-command' contains the original
3045 command before remapping. It is equal to `this-command' when the
3046 command was not remapped.
3047
3048 *** If text has a `keymap' property, that keymap takes precedence
3049 over minor mode keymaps.
3050
3051 *** The `keymap' property now also works at the ends of overlays and
3052 text-properties, according to their stickiness. This also means that it
3053 works with empty overlays. The same hold for the `local-map' property.
3054
3055 *** Dense keymaps now handle inheritance correctly.
3056 Previously a dense keymap would hide all of the simple-char key
3057 bindings of the parent keymap.
3058
3059 *** `define-key-after' now accepts keys longer than 1.
3060
3061 *** New function `current-active-maps' returns a list of currently
3062 active keymaps.
3063
3064 *** New function `describe-buffer-bindings' inserts the list of all
3065 defined keys and their definitions.
3066
3067 *** New function `keymap-prompt' returns the prompt-string of a keymap
3068
3069 *** (map-keymap FUNCTION KEYMAP) applies the function to each binding
3070 in the keymap.
3071
3072 *** New variable emulation-mode-map-alists.
3073
3074 Lisp packages using many minor mode keymaps can now maintain their own
3075 keymap alist separate from minor-mode-map-alist by adding their keymap
3076 alist to this list.
3077
3078 +++
3079 ** Atomic change groups.
3080
3081 To perform some changes in the current buffer "atomically" so that
3082 they either all succeed or are all undone, use `atomic-change-group'
3083 around the code that makes changes. For instance:
3084
3085 (atomic-change-group
3086 (insert foo)
3087 (delete-region x y))
3088
3089 If an error (or other nonlocal exit) occurs inside the body of
3090 `atomic-change-group', it unmakes all the changes in that buffer that
3091 were during the execution of the body. The change group has no effect
3092 on any other buffers--any such changes remain.
3093
3094 If you need something more sophisticated, you can directly call the
3095 lower-level functions that `atomic-change-group' uses. Here is how.
3096
3097 To set up a change group for one buffer, call `prepare-change-group'.
3098 Specify the buffer as argument; it defaults to the current buffer.
3099 This function returns a "handle" for the change group. You must save
3100 the handle to activate the change group and then finish it.
3101
3102 Before you change the buffer again, you must activate the change
3103 group. Pass the handle to `activate-change-group' afterward to
3104 do this.
3105
3106 After you make the changes, you must finish the change group. You can
3107 either accept the changes or cancel them all. Call
3108 `accept-change-group' to accept the changes in the group as final;
3109 call `cancel-change-group' to undo them all.
3110
3111 You should use `unwind-protect' to make sure the group is always
3112 finished. The call to `activate-change-group' should be inside the
3113 `unwind-protect', in case the user types C-g just after it runs.
3114 (This is one reason why `prepare-change-group' and
3115 `activate-change-group' are separate functions.) Once you finish the
3116 group, don't use the handle again--don't try to finish the same group
3117 twice.
3118
3119 To make a multibuffer change group, call `prepare-change-group' once
3120 for each buffer you want to cover, then use `nconc' to combine the
3121 returned values, like this:
3122
3123 (nconc (prepare-change-group buffer-1)
3124 (prepare-change-group buffer-2))
3125
3126 You can then activate the multibuffer change group with a single call
3127 to `activate-change-group', and finish it with a single call to
3128 `accept-change-group' or `cancel-change-group'.
3129
3130 Nested use of several change groups for the same buffer works as you
3131 would expect. Non-nested use of change groups for the same buffer
3132 will lead to undesirable results, so don't let it happen; the first
3133 change group you start for any given buffer should be the last one
3134 finished.
3135
3136 +++
3137 ** Progress reporters.
3138 The new functions `make-progress-reporter', `progress-reporter-update',
3139 `progress-reporter-force-update', `progress-reporter-done', and
3140 `dotimes-with-progress-reporter' provide a simple and efficient way for
3141 a command to present progress messages for the user.
3142
3143 +++
3144 ** New `yank-handler' text property may be used to control how
3145 previously killed text on the kill-ring is reinserted.
3146
3147 The value of the yank-handler property must be a list with one to four
3148 elements with the following format:
3149 (FUNCTION PARAM NOEXCLUDE UNDO).
3150
3151 The `insert-for-yank' function looks for a yank-handler property on
3152 the first character on its string argument (typically the first
3153 element on the kill-ring). If a yank-handler property is found,
3154 the normal behavior of `insert-for-yank' is modified in various ways:
3155
3156 When FUNCTION is present and non-nil, it is called instead of `insert'
3157 to insert the string. FUNCTION takes one argument--the object to insert.
3158 If PARAM is present and non-nil, it replaces STRING as the object
3159 passed to FUNCTION (or `insert'); for example, if FUNCTION is
3160 `yank-rectangle', PARAM should be a list of strings to insert as a
3161 rectangle.
3162 If NOEXCLUDE is present and non-nil, the normal removal of the
3163 yank-excluded-properties is not performed; instead FUNCTION is
3164 responsible for removing those properties. This may be necessary
3165 if FUNCTION adjusts point before or after inserting the object.
3166 If UNDO is present and non-nil, it is a function that will be called
3167 by `yank-pop' to undo the insertion of the current object. It is
3168 called with two arguments, the start and end of the current region.
3169 FUNCTION may set `yank-undo-function' to override the UNDO value.
3170
3171 *** The functions kill-new, kill-append, and kill-region now have an
3172 optional argument to specify the yank-handler text property to put on
3173 the killed text.
3174
3175 *** The function yank-pop will now use a non-nil value of the variable
3176 `yank-undo-function' (instead of delete-region) to undo the previous
3177 yank or yank-pop command (or a call to insert-for-yank). The function
3178 insert-for-yank automatically sets that variable according to the UNDO
3179 element of the string argument's yank-handler text property if present.
3180
3181 *** The function `insert-for-yank' now supports strings where the
3182 `yank-handler' property does not span the first character of the
3183 string. The old behavior is available if you call
3184 `insert-for-yank-1' instead.
3185
3186 *** The new function insert-for-yank normally works like `insert', but
3187 removes the text properties in the `yank-excluded-properties' list.
3188 However, the insertion of the text may be modified by a `yank-handler'
3189 text property.
3190
3191 +++
3192 ** An element of buffer-undo-list can now have the form (apply FUNNAME
3193 . ARGS), where FUNNAME is a symbol other than t or nil. That stands
3194 for a high-level change that should be undone by evaluating (apply
3195 FUNNAME ARGS).
3196
3197 These entries can also have the form (apply DELTA BEG END FUNNAME . ARGS)
3198 which indicates that the change which took place was limited to the
3199 range BEG...END and increased the buffer size by DELTA.
3200
3201 +++
3202 ** If the buffer's undo list for the current command gets longer than
3203 undo-outer-limit, garbage collection empties it. This is to prevent
3204 it from using up the available memory and choking Emacs.
3205
3206 +++
3207 ** Enhancements to process support
3208
3209 *** Function list-processes now has an optional argument; if non-nil,
3210 only the processes whose query-on-exit flag is set are listed.
3211
3212 *** New set-process-query-on-exit-flag and process-query-on-exit-flag
3213 functions. The existing process-kill-without-query function is still
3214 supported, but new code should use the new functions.
3215
3216 *** Function signal-process now accepts a process object or process
3217 name in addition to a process id to identify the signalled process.
3218
3219 *** Processes now have an associated property list where programs can
3220 maintain process state and other per-process related information.
3221
3222 The new functions process-get and process-put are used to access, add,
3223 and modify elements on this property list.
3224
3225 The new low-level functions process-plist and set-process-plist are
3226 used to access and replace the entire property list of a process.
3227
3228 *** Function accept-process-output now has an optional fourth arg
3229 `just-this-one'. If non-nil, only output from the specified process
3230 is handled, suspending output from other processes. If value is an
3231 integer, also inhibit running timers. This feature is generally not
3232 recommended, but may be necessary for specific applications, such as
3233 speech synthesis.
3234
3235 *** Adaptive read buffering of subprocess output.
3236
3237 On some systems, when emacs reads the output from a subprocess, the
3238 output data is read in very small blocks, potentially resulting in
3239 very poor performance. This behavior can be remedied to some extent
3240 by setting the new variable process-adaptive-read-buffering to a
3241 non-nil value (the default), as it will automatically delay reading
3242 from such processes, to allowing them to produce more output before
3243 emacs tries to read it.
3244
3245 *** The new function `call-process-shell-command' executes a shell
3246 command command synchronously in a separate process.
3247
3248 *** The new function `process-file' is similar to `call-process', but
3249 obeys file handlers. The file handler is chosen based on
3250 default-directory.
3251
3252 *** The new function `set-process-filter-multibyte' sets the
3253 multibyteness of a string given to a process's filter.
3254
3255 *** The new function `process-filter-multibyte-p' returns t if a
3256 string given to a process's filter is multibyte.
3257
3258 *** A filter function of a process is called with a multibyte string
3259 if the filter's multibyteness is t. That multibyteness is decided by
3260 the value of `default-enable-multibyte-characters' when the process is
3261 created and can be changed later by `set-process-filter-multibyte'.
3262
3263 *** If a process's coding system is raw-text or no-conversion and its
3264 buffer is multibyte, the output of the process is at first converted
3265 to multibyte by `string-to-multibyte' then inserted in the buffer.
3266 Previously, it was converted to multibyte by `string-as-multibyte',
3267 which was not compatible with the behavior of file reading.
3268
3269 +++
3270 ** Enhanced networking support.
3271
3272 *** There is a new `make-network-process' function which supports
3273 opening of stream and datagram connections to a server, as well as
3274 create a stream or datagram server inside emacs.
3275
3276 - A server is started using :server t arg.
3277 - Datagram connection is selected using :type 'datagram arg.
3278 - A server can open on a random port using :service t arg.
3279 - Local sockets are supported using :family 'local arg.
3280 - Non-blocking connect is supported using :nowait t arg.
3281 - The process' property list may be initialized using :plist PLIST arg;
3282 a copy of the server process' property list is automatically inherited
3283 by new client processes created to handle incoming connections.
3284
3285 To test for the availability of a given feature, use featurep like this:
3286 (featurep 'make-network-process '(:type datagram))
3287
3288 *** Original open-network-stream is now emulated using make-network-process.
3289
3290 *** New function open-network-stream-nowait.
3291
3292 This function initiates a non-blocking connect and returns immediately
3293 without waiting for the connection to be established. It takes the
3294 filter and sentinel functions as arguments; when the non-blocking
3295 connect completes, the sentinel is called with a status string
3296 matching "open" or "failed".
3297
3298 *** New function open-network-stream-server.
3299
3300 This function creates a network server process for a TCP service.
3301 When a client connects to the specified service, a new subprocess
3302 is created to handle the new connection, and the sentinel function
3303 is called for the new process.
3304
3305 *** New functions process-datagram-address and set-process-datagram-address.
3306
3307 These functions are used with datagram-based network processes to get
3308 and set the current address of the remote partner.
3309
3310 *** New function format-network-address.
3311
3312 This function reformats the lisp representation of a network address
3313 to a printable string. For example, an IP address A.B.C.D and port
3314 number P is represented as a five element vector [A B C D P], and the
3315 printable string returned for this vector is "A.B.C.D:P". See the doc
3316 string for other formatting options.
3317
3318 *** By default, the function process-contact still returns (HOST SERVICE)
3319 for a network process. Using the new optional KEY arg, the complete list
3320 of network process properties or a specific property can be selected.
3321
3322 Using :local and :remote as the KEY, the address of the local or
3323 remote end-point is returned. An Inet address is represented as a 5
3324 element vector, where the first 4 elements contain the IP address and
3325 the fifth is the port number.
3326
3327 *** Network processes can now be stopped and restarted with
3328 `stop-process' and `continue-process'. For a server process, no
3329 connections are accepted in the stopped state. For a client process,
3330 no input is received in the stopped state.
3331
3332 *** New function network-interface-list.
3333
3334 This function returns a list of network interface names and their
3335 current network addresses.
3336
3337 *** New function network-interface-info.
3338
3339 This function returns the network address, hardware address, current
3340 status, and other information about a specific network interface.
3341
3342 *** The sentinel is now called when a network process is deleted with
3343 delete-process. The status message passed to the sentinel for a
3344 deleted network process is "deleted". The message passed to the
3345 sentinel when the connection is closed by the remote peer has been
3346 changed to "connection broken by remote peer".
3347
3348 +++
3349 ** New function `force-window-update' can initiate a full redisplay of
3350 one or all windows. Normally, this is not needed as changes in window
3351 contents are detected automatically. However, certain implicit
3352 changes to mode lines, header lines, or display properties may require
3353 forcing an explicit window update.
3354
3355 +++
3356 ** You can now make a window as short as one line.
3357
3358 A window that is just one line tall does not display either a mode
3359 line or a header line, even if the variables `mode-line-format' and
3360 `header-line-format' call for them. A window that is two lines tall
3361 cannot display both a mode line and a header line at once; if the
3362 variables call for both, only the mode line actually appears.
3363
3364 +++
3365 ** The line-move, scroll-up, and scroll-down functions will now
3366 modify the window vscroll to scroll through display rows that are
3367 taller that the height of the window, for example in the presense of
3368 large images. To disable this feature, Lisp code may bind the new
3369 variable `auto-window-vscroll' to nil.
3370
3371 +++
3372 ** Function `compute-motion' now calculates the usable window
3373 width if the WIDTH argument is nil. If the TOPOS argument is nil,
3374 the usable window height and width is used.
3375
3376 +++
3377 ** Function pos-visible-in-window-p now returns the pixel coordinates
3378 and partial visiblity state of the corresponding row, if the PARTIALLY
3379 arg is non-nil.
3380
3381 +++
3382 ** The new function `window-inside-edges' returns the edges of the
3383 actual text portion of the window, not including the scroll bar or
3384 divider line, the fringes, the display margins, the header line and
3385 the mode line.
3386
3387 +++
3388 ** The new functions `window-pixel-edges' and `window-inside-pixel-edges'
3389 return window edges in units of pixels, rather than columns and lines.
3390
3391 +++
3392 ** The new macro `with-selected-window' temporarily switches the
3393 selected window without impacting the order of buffer-list.
3394
3395 +++
3396 ** `select-window' takes an optional second argument `norecord', like
3397 `switch-to-buffer'.
3398
3399 +++
3400 ** `save-selected-window' now saves and restores the selected window
3401 of every frame. This way, it restores everything that can be changed
3402 by calling `select-window'.
3403
3404 +++
3405 ** The function `set-window-buffer' now has an optional third argument
3406 KEEP-MARGINS which will preserve the window's current margin, fringe,
3407 and scroll-bar settings if non-nil.
3408
3409 +++
3410 ** Customizable fringe bitmaps
3411
3412 *** New function 'define-fringe-bitmap' can now be used to create new
3413 fringe bitmaps, as well as change the built-in fringe bitmaps.
3414
3415 To change a built-in bitmap, do (require 'fringe) and use the symbol
3416 identifing the bitmap such as `left-truncation or `continued-line'.
3417
3418 *** New function 'destroy-fringe-bitmap' may be used to destroy a
3419 previously created bitmap, or restore a built-in bitmap.
3420
3421 *** New function 'set-fringe-bitmap-face' can now be used to set a
3422 specific face to be used for a specific fringe bitmap. The face is
3423 automatically merged with the `fringe' face, so normally, the face
3424 should only specify the foreground color of the bitmap.
3425
3426 *** There are new display properties, left-fringe and right-fringe,
3427 that can be used to show a specific bitmap in the left or right fringe
3428 bitmap of the display line.
3429
3430 Format is 'display '(left-fringe BITMAP [FACE]), where BITMAP is a
3431 symbol identifying a fringe bitmap, either built-in or defined with
3432 `define-fringe-bitmap', and FACE is an optional face name to be used
3433 for displaying the bitmap instead of the default `fringe' face.
3434 When specified, FACE is automatically merged with the `fringe' face.
3435
3436 *** New function `fringe-bitmaps-at-pos' returns the current fringe
3437 bitmaps in the display line at a given buffer position.
3438
3439 +++
3440 ** Controlling the default left and right fringe widths.
3441
3442 The default left and right fringe widths for all windows of a frame
3443 can now be controlled by setting the `left-fringe' and `right-fringe'
3444 frame parameters to an integer value specifying the width in pixels.
3445 Setting the width to 0 effectively removes the corresponding fringe.
3446
3447 The actual default fringe widths for the frame may deviate from the
3448 specified widths, since the combined fringe widths must match an
3449 integral number of columns. The extra width is distributed evenly
3450 between the left and right fringe. For force a specific fringe width,
3451 specify the width as a negative integer (if both widths are negative,
3452 only the left fringe gets the specified width).
3453
3454 Setting the width to nil (the default), restores the default fringe
3455 width which is the minimum number of pixels necessary to display any
3456 of the currently defined fringe bitmaps. The width of the built-in
3457 fringe bitmaps is 8 pixels.
3458
3459 +++
3460 ** Per-window fringe and scrollbar settings
3461
3462 *** Windows can now have their own individual fringe widths and
3463 position settings.
3464
3465 To control the fringe widths of a window, either set the buffer-local
3466 variables `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', or call
3467 `set-window-fringes'.
3468
3469 To control the fringe position in a window, that is, whether fringes
3470 are positioned between the display margins and the window's text area,
3471 or at the edges of the window, either set the buffer-local variable
3472 `fringes-outside-margins' or call `set-window-fringes'.
3473
3474 The function `window-fringes' can be used to obtain the current
3475 settings. To make `left-fringe-width', `right-fringe-width', and
3476 `fringes-outside-margins' take effect, you must set them before
3477 displaying the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force
3478 an update of the display margins.
3479
3480 *** Windows can now have their own individual scroll-bar settings
3481 controlling the width and position of scroll-bars.
3482
3483 To control the scroll-bar of a window, either set the buffer-local
3484 variables `scroll-bar-mode' and `scroll-bar-width', or call
3485 `set-window-scroll-bars'. The function `window-scroll-bars' can be
3486 used to obtain the current settings. To make `scroll-bar-mode' and
3487 `scroll-bar-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
3488 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
3489 of the display margins.
3490
3491 +++
3492 ** When using non-toolkit scroll bars with the default width,
3493 the scroll-bar-width frame parameter value is nil.
3494
3495 +++
3496 ** Multiple overlay arrows can now be defined and managed via the new
3497 variable `overlay-arrow-variable-list'. It contains a list of
3498 varibles which contain overlay arrow position markers, including
3499 the original `overlay-arrow-position' variable.
3500
3501 Each variable on this list may have individual `overlay-arrow-string'
3502 and `overlay-arrow-bitmap' properties that specify an overlay arrow
3503 string (for non-window terminals) or fringe bitmap (for window
3504 systems) to display at the corresponding overlay arrow position.
3505 If either property is not set, the default `overlay-arrow-string' or
3506 'overlay-arrow-fringe-bitmap' will be used.
3507
3508 +++
3509 ** New line-height and line-spacing properties for newline characters
3510
3511 A newline may now have line-height and line-spacing text or overlay
3512 properties that control the height of the corresponding display row.
3513
3514 If the line-height property value is t, the newline does not
3515 contribute to the height of the display row; instead the height of the
3516 newline glyph is reduced. Also, a line-spacing property on this
3517 newline is ignored. This can be used to tile small images or image
3518 slices without adding blank areas between the images.
3519
3520 If the line-height property value is a positive integer, the value
3521 specifies the minimum line height in pixels. If necessary, the line
3522 height it increased by increasing the line's ascent.
3523
3524 If the line-height property value is a float, the minimum line height
3525 is calculated by multiplying the default frame line height by the
3526 given value.
3527
3528 If the line-height property value is a cons (FACE . RATIO), the
3529 minimum line height is calculated as RATIO * height of named FACE.
3530 RATIO is int or float. If FACE is t, it specifies the current face.
3531
3532 If the line-height property value is a cons (nil . RATIO), the line
3533 height is calculated as RATIO * actual height of the line's contents.
3534
3535 If the line-height value is a cons (HEIGHT . TOTAL), HEIGHT specifies
3536 the line height as described above, while TOTAL is any of the forms
3537 described above and specifies the total height of the line, causing a
3538 varying number of pixels to be inserted after the line to make it line
3539 exactly that many pixels high.
3540
3541 If the line-spacing property value is an positive integer, the value
3542 is used as additional pixels to insert after the display line; this
3543 overrides the default frame line-spacing and any buffer local value of
3544 the line-spacing variable.
3545
3546 If the line-spacing property may be a float or cons, the line spacing
3547 is calculated as specified above for the line-height property.
3548
3549 +++
3550 ** The buffer local line-spacing variable may now have a float value,
3551 which is used as a height relative to the default frame line height.
3552
3553 +++
3554 ** Enhancements to stretch display properties
3555
3556 The display property stretch specification form `(space PROPS)', where
3557 PROPS is a property list now allows pixel based width and height
3558 specifications, as well as enhanced horizontal text alignment.
3559
3560 The value of these properties can now be a (primitive) expression
3561 which is evaluated during redisplay. The following expressions
3562 are supported:
3563
3564 EXPR ::= NUM | (NUM) | UNIT | ELEM | POS | IMAGE | FORM
3565 NUM ::= INTEGER | FLOAT | SYMBOL
3566 UNIT ::= in | mm | cm | width | height
3567 ELEM ::= left-fringe | right-fringe | left-margin | right-margin
3568 | scroll-bar | text
3569 POS ::= left | center | right
3570 FORM ::= (NUM . EXPR) | (OP EXPR ...)
3571 OP ::= + | -
3572
3573 The form `NUM' specifies a fractional width or height of the default
3574 frame font size. The form `(NUM)' specifies an absolute number of
3575 pixels. If a symbol is specified, its buffer-local variable binding
3576 is used. The `in', `mm', and `cm' units specifies the number of
3577 pixels per inch, milli-meter, and centi-meter, resp. The `width' and
3578 `height' units correspond to the width and height of the current face
3579 font. An image specification corresponds to the width or height of
3580 the image.
3581
3582 The `left-fringe', `right-fringe', `left-margin', `right-margin',
3583 `scroll-bar', and `text' elements specify to the width of the
3584 corresponding area of the window.
3585
3586 The `left', `center', and `right' positions can be used with :align-to
3587 to specify a position relative to the left edge, center, or right edge
3588 of the text area. One of the above window elements (except `text')
3589 can also be used with :align-to to specify that the position is
3590 relative to the left edge of the given area. Once the base offset for
3591 a relative position has been set (by the first occurrence of one of
3592 these symbols), further occurences of these symbols are interpreted as
3593 the width of the area.
3594
3595 For example, to align to the center of the left-margin, use
3596 :align-to (+ left-margin (0.5 . left-margin))
3597
3598 If no specific base offset is set for alignment, it is always relative
3599 to the left edge of the text area. For example, :align-to 0 in a
3600 header-line aligns with the first text column in the text area.
3601
3602 The value of the form `(NUM . EXPR)' is the value of NUM multiplied by
3603 the value of the expression EXPR. For example, (2 . in) specifies a
3604 width of 2 inches, while (0.5 . IMAGE) specifies half the width (or
3605 height) of the specified image.
3606
3607 The form `(+ EXPR ...)' adds up the value of the expressions.
3608 The form `(- EXPR ...)' negates or subtracts the value of the expressions.
3609
3610 +++
3611 ** Support for displaying image slices
3612
3613 *** New display property (slice X Y WIDTH HEIGHT) may be used with
3614 an image property to display only a specific slice of the image.
3615
3616 *** Function insert-image has new optional fourth arg to
3617 specify image slice (X Y WIDTH HEIGHT).
3618
3619 *** New function insert-sliced-image inserts a given image as a
3620 specified number of evenly sized slices (rows x columns).
3621
3622 +++
3623 ** Images may now have an associated image map via the :map property.
3624
3625 An image map is an alist where each element has the format (AREA ID PLIST).
3626 An AREA is specified as either a rectangle, a circle, or a polygon:
3627 A rectangle is a cons (rect . ((x0 . y0) . (x1 . y1))) specifying the
3628 pixel coordinates of the upper left and bottom right corners.
3629 A circle is a cons (circle . ((x0 . y0) . r)) specifying the center
3630 and the radius of the circle; r may be a float or integer.
3631 A polygon is a cons (poly . [x0 y0 x1 y1 ...]) where each pair in the
3632 vector describes one corner in the polygon.
3633
3634 When the mouse pointer is above a hot-spot area of an image, the
3635 PLIST of that hot-spot is consulted; if it contains a `help-echo'
3636 property it defines a tool-tip for the hot-spot, and if it contains
3637 a `pointer' property, it defines the shape of the mouse cursor when
3638 it is over the hot-spot. See the variable 'void-area-text-pointer'
3639 for possible pointer shapes.
3640
3641 When you click the mouse when the mouse pointer is over a hot-spot,
3642 an event is composed by combining the ID of the hot-spot with the
3643 mouse event, e.g. [area4 mouse-1] if the hot-spot's ID is `area4'.
3644
3645 +++ (lispref)
3646 ??? (man)
3647 ** The mouse pointer shape in void text areas (i.e. after the end of a
3648 line or below the last line in the buffer) of the text window is now
3649 controlled by the new variable `void-text-area-pointer'. The default
3650 is to use the `arrow' (non-text) pointer. Other choices are `text'
3651 (or nil), `hand', `vdrag', `hdrag', `modeline', and `hourglass'.
3652
3653 +++
3654 ** The mouse pointer shape over an image can now be controlled by the
3655 :pointer image property.
3656
3657 +++
3658 ** Lisp code can now test if a given buffer position is inside a
3659 clickable link with the new function `mouse-on-link-p'. This is the
3660 function used by the new `mouse-1-click-follows-link' functionality.
3661
3662 +++
3663 ** The mouse pointer shape over ordinary text or images may now be
3664 controlled/overriden via the `pointer' text property.
3665
3666 ** Mouse event enhancements:
3667
3668 +++
3669 *** Mouse clicks on fringes now generates left-fringe or right-fringes
3670 events, rather than a text area click event.
3671
3672 +++
3673 *** Mouse clicks in the left and right marginal areas now includes a
3674 sensible buffer position corresponding to the first character in the
3675 corresponding text row.
3676
3677 +++
3678 *** Function `mouse-set-point' now works for events outside text area.
3679
3680 +++
3681 *** Mouse events now includes buffer position for all event types.
3682
3683 +++
3684 *** `posn-point' now returns buffer position for non-text area events.
3685
3686 +++
3687 *** New function `posn-area' returns window area clicked on (nil means
3688 text area).
3689
3690 +++
3691 *** Mouse events include actual glyph column and row for all event types.
3692
3693 +++
3694 *** New function `posn-actual-col-row' returns actual glyph coordinates.
3695
3696 +++
3697 *** Mouse events may now include image object in addition to string object.
3698
3699 +++
3700 *** Mouse events include relative x and y pixel coordinates relative to
3701 the top left corner of the object (image or character) clicked on.
3702
3703 +++
3704 *** Mouse events include the pixel width and height of the object
3705 (image or character) clicked on.
3706
3707 +++
3708 *** New functions 'posn-object', 'posn-object-x-y', and
3709 'posn-object-width-height' return the image or string object of a mouse
3710 click, the x and y pixel coordinates relative to the top left corner
3711 of that object, and the total width and height of that object.
3712
3713 +++
3714 ** At the end of a command, point moves out from within invisible
3715 text, in the same way it moves out from within text covered by an
3716 image or composition property.
3717
3718 This makes it generally unnecessary to mark invisible text as intangible.
3719 This is particularly good because the intangible property often has
3720 unexpected side-effects since the property applies to everything
3721 (including `goto-char', ...) whereas this new code is only run after
3722 post-command-hook and thus does not care about intermediate states.
3723
3724 +++
3725 ** Normally, the cursor is displayed at the end of any overlay and
3726 text property string that may be present at the current window
3727 position. The cursor may now be placed on any character of such
3728 strings by giving that character a non-nil `cursor' text property.
3729
3730 +++
3731 ** The display space :width and :align-to text properties are now
3732 supported on text terminals.
3733
3734 +++
3735 ** Arguments for remove-overlays are now optional, so that you can
3736 remove all overlays in the buffer by just calling (remove-overlay).
3737
3738 +++
3739 ** New variable char-property-alias-alist.
3740
3741 This variable allows you to create alternative names for text
3742 properties. It works at the same level as `default-text-properties',
3743 although it applies to overlays as well. This variable was introduced
3744 to implement the `font-lock-face' property.
3745
3746 +++
3747 ** New function `get-char-property-and-overlay' accepts the same
3748 arguments as `get-char-property' and returns a cons whose car is the
3749 return value of `get-char-property' called with those arguments and
3750 whose cdr is the overlay in which the property was found, or nil if
3751 it was found as a text property or not found at all.
3752
3753 +++
3754 ** The new frame parameter `tty-color-mode' specifies the mode to use
3755 for color support on character terminal frames. Its value can be a
3756 number of colors to support, or a symbol. See the Emacs Lisp
3757 Reference manual for more detailed documentation.
3758
3759 +++
3760 ** The new face attribute `min-colors' can be used to tailor the face
3761 color to the number of colors supported by a display, and define the
3762 foreground and background colors accordingly so that they look best on
3763 a terminal that supports at least this many colors. This is now the
3764 preferred method for defining default faces in a way that makes a good
3765 use of the capabilities of the display.
3766
3767 +++
3768 ** (char-displayable-p CHAR) returns non-nil if Emacs ought to be able
3769 to display CHAR. More precisely, if the selected frame's fontset has
3770 a font to display the character set that CHAR belongs to.
3771
3772 Fontsets can specify a font on a per-character basis; when the fontset
3773 does that, this value may not be accurate.
3774
3775 +++
3776 ** New function display-supports-face-attributes-p may be used to test
3777 whether a given set of face attributes is actually displayable.
3778
3779 A new predicate `supports' has also been added to the `defface' face
3780 specification language, which can be used to do this test for faces
3781 defined with defface.
3782
3783 ---
3784 ** The special treatment of faces whose names are of the form `fg:COLOR'
3785 or `bg:COLOR' has been removed. Lisp programs should use the
3786 `defface' facility for defining faces with specific colors, or use
3787 the feature of specifying the face attributes :foreground and :background
3788 directly in the `face' property instead of using a named face.
3789
3790 +++
3791 ** The first face specification element in a defface can specify
3792 `default' instead of frame classification. Then its attributes act as
3793 defaults that apply to all the subsequent cases (and may be overridden
3794 by them).
3795
3796 +++
3797 ** The variable `face-font-rescale-alist' specifies how much larger
3798 (or smaller) font we should use. For instance, if the value is
3799 '((SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN . 1.3)) and a face requests a font of 10
3800 point, we actually use a font of 13 point if the font matches
3801 SOME-FONTNAME-PATTERN.
3802
3803 ---
3804 ** `set-fontset-font', `fontset-info', `fontset-font' now operate on
3805 the default fontset if the argument NAME is nil..
3806
3807 ---
3808 ** The function face-differs-from-default-p now truly checks whether the
3809 given face displays differently from the default face or not (previously
3810 it did only a very cursory check).
3811
3812 +++
3813 ** face-attribute, face-foreground, face-background, and face-stipple now
3814 accept a new optional argument, INHERIT, which controls how face
3815 inheritance is used when determining the value of a face attribute.
3816
3817 +++
3818 ** New functions face-attribute-relative-p and merge-face-attribute
3819 help with handling relative face attributes.
3820
3821 +++
3822 ** The priority of faces in an :inherit attribute face-list is reversed.
3823 If a face contains an :inherit attribute with a list of faces, earlier
3824 faces in the list override later faces in the list; in previous releases
3825 of Emacs, the order was the opposite. This change was made so that
3826 :inherit face-lists operate identically to face-lists in text `face'
3827 properties.
3828
3829 +++
3830 ** New standard font-lock face `font-lock-preprocessor-face'.
3831
3832 +++
3833 ** New special text property `font-lock-face'.
3834
3835 This property acts like the `face' property, but it is controlled by
3836 M-x font-lock-mode. It is not, strictly speaking, a builtin text
3837 property. Instead, it is implemented inside font-core.el, using the
3838 new variable `char-property-alias-alist'.
3839
3840 ---
3841 ** jit-lock obeys a new text-property `jit-lock-defer-multiline'.
3842 If a piece of text with that property gets contextually refontified
3843 (see jit-lock-defer-contextually), then all of that text will
3844 be refontified. This is useful when the syntax of a textual element
3845 depends on text several lines further down (and when font-lock-multiline
3846 is not appropriate to solve that problem). For example in Perl:
3847
3848 s{
3849 foo
3850 }{
3851 bar
3852 }e
3853
3854 Adding/removing the last `e' changes the `bar' from being a piece of
3855 text to being a piece of code, so you'd put a jit-lock-defer-multiline
3856 property over the second half of the command to force (deferred)
3857 refontification of `bar' whenever the `e' is added/removed.
3858
3859 +++
3860 ** font-lock can manage arbitrary text-properties beside `face'.
3861 *** the FACENAME returned in font-lock-keywords can be a list
3862 of the form (face FACE PROP1 VAL1 PROP2 VAL2 ...) so you can set
3863 other properties than `face'.
3864 *** font-lock-extra-managed-props can be set to make sure those extra
3865 properties are automatically cleaned up by font-lock.
3866
3867 ---
3868 ** The precedence of file-name-handlers has been changed.
3869 Instead of blindly choosing the first handler that matches,
3870 find-file-name-handler now gives precedence to a file-name handler
3871 that matches near the end of the file name. More specifically, the
3872 handler whose (match-beginning 0) is the largest is chosen.
3873 In case of ties, the old "first matched" rule applies.
3874
3875 +++
3876 ** A file name handler can declare which operations it handles.
3877
3878 You do this by putting an `operation' property on the handler name
3879 symbol. The property value should be a list of the operations that
3880 the handler really handles. It won't be called for any other
3881 operations.
3882
3883 This is useful for autoloaded handlers, to prevent them from being
3884 autoloaded when not really necessary.
3885
3886 +++
3887 ** `set-auto-mode' now gives the interpreter magic line (if present)
3888 precedence over the file name. Likewise an <?xml or <!DOCTYPE declaration
3889 will give the buffer XML or SGML mode, based on the new var
3890 `magic-mode-alist'.
3891
3892 +++
3893 ** Major mode functions now run the new normal hook
3894 `after-change-major-mode-hook', at their very end, after the mode hooks.
3895
3896 ---
3897 ** If a major mode function has a non-nil `no-clone-indirect'
3898 property, `clone-indirect-buffer' signals an error if you use
3899 it in that buffer.
3900
3901 +++
3902 ** Major modes can define `eldoc-documentation-function'
3903 locally to provide Eldoc functionality by some method appropriate to
3904 the language.
3905
3906 +++
3907 ** define-derived-mode by default creates a new empty abbrev table.
3908 It does not copy abbrevs from the parent mode's abbrev table.
3909
3910 +++
3911 ** define-minor-mode now accepts arbitrary additional keyword arguments
3912 and simply passes them to defcustom, if applicable.
3913
3914 +++
3915 ** The new function `run-mode-hooks' and the new macro `delay-mode-hooks'
3916 are used by define-derived-mode to make sure the mode hook for the
3917 parent mode is run at the end of the child mode.
3918
3919 +++
3920 ** `minor-mode-list' now holds a list of minor mode commands.
3921
3922 +++
3923 ** Both the variable and the function `disabled-command-hook' have
3924 been renamed to `disabled-command-function'. The variable
3925 `disabled-command-hook' has been kept as an obsolete alias.
3926
3927 +++
3928 ** The function `eql' is now available without requiring the CL package.
3929
3930 +++
3931 ** If optional third argument APPEND to `add-to-list' is non-nil, a
3932 new element gets added at the end of the list instead of at the
3933 beginning. This change actually occurred in Emacs-21.1, but was not
3934 documented.
3935
3936 +++
3937 ** The escape sequence \s is now interpreted as a SPACE character,
3938 unless it is followed by a `-' in a character constant (e.g. ?\s-A),
3939 in which case it is still interpreted as the super modifier.
3940 In strings, \s is always interpreted as a space.
3941
3942 +++
3943 ** A hex escape in a string forces the string to be multibyte.
3944 An octal escape makes it unibyte.
3945
3946 +++
3947 ** `split-string' now includes null substrings in the returned list if
3948 the optional argument SEPARATORS is non-nil and there are matches for
3949 SEPARATORS at the beginning or end of the string. If SEPARATORS is
3950 nil, or if the new optional third argument OMIT-NULLS is non-nil, all
3951 empty matches are omitted from the returned list.
3952
3953 +++
3954 ** New function `string-to-multibyte' converts a unibyte string to a
3955 multibyte string with the same individual character codes.
3956
3957 +++
3958 ** The function `number-sequence' returns a list of equally-separated
3959 numbers. For instance, (number-sequence 4 9) returns (4 5 6 7 8 9).
3960 By default, the separation is 1, but you can specify a different separation
3961 as the third argument. (number-sequence 1.5 6 2) returns (1.5 3.5 5.5).
3962
3963 +++
3964 ** `sit-for' can now be called with args (SECONDS &optional NODISP).
3965
3966 +++
3967 ** A function's docstring can now hold the function's usage info on
3968 its last line. It should match the regexp "\n\n(fn.*)\\'".
3969
3970 +++
3971 ** The `defmacro' form may contain declarations specifying how to
3972 indent the macro in Lisp mode and how to debug it with Edebug. The
3973 syntax of defmacro has been extended to
3974
3975 (defmacro NAME LAMBDA-LIST [DOC-STRING] [DECLARATION ...] ...)
3976
3977 DECLARATION is a list `(declare DECLARATION-SPECIFIER ...)'. The
3978 declaration specifiers supported are:
3979
3980 (indent INDENT)
3981 Set NAME's `lisp-indent-function' property to INDENT.
3982
3983 (edebug DEBUG)
3984 Set NAME's `edebug-form-spec' property to DEBUG. (This is
3985 equivalent to writing a `def-edebug-spec' for the macro.
3986
3987 +++
3988 ** The functions all-completions and try-completion now accept lists
3989 of strings as well as hash-tables additionally to alists, obarrays
3990 and functions. Furthermore, the function `test-completion' is now
3991 exported to Lisp. The keys in alists and hash tables may be either
3992 strings or symbols, which are automatically converted with to strings.
3993
3994 +++
3995 ** The new macro dynamic-completion-table supports using functions
3996 as a dynamic completion table.
3997
3998 (dynamic-completion-table FUN)
3999
4000 FUN is called with one argument, the string for which completion is required,
4001 and it should return an alist containing all the intended possible
4002 completions. This alist may be a full list of possible completions so that FUN
4003 can ignore the value of its argument. If completion is performed in the
4004 minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer from which the minibuffer was
4005 entered. dynamic-completion-table then computes the completion.
4006
4007 +++
4008 ** The new macro lazy-completion-table initializes a variable
4009 as a lazy completion table.
4010
4011 (lazy-completion-table VAR FUN &rest ARGS)
4012
4013 If the completion table VAR is used for the first time (e.g., by passing VAR
4014 as an argument to `try-completion'), the function FUN is called with arguments
4015 ARGS. FUN must return the completion table that will be stored in VAR. If
4016 completion is requested in the minibuffer, FUN will be called in the buffer
4017 from which the minibuffer was entered. The return value of
4018 `lazy-completion-table' must be used to initialize the value of VAR.
4019
4020 +++
4021 ** `load-history' can now have elements of the form (t . FUNNAME),
4022 which means FUNNAME was previously defined as an autoload (before the
4023 current file redefined it).
4024
4025 +++
4026 ** `load-history' now records (defun . FUNNAME) when a function is
4027 defined. For a variable, it records just the variable name.
4028
4029 ---
4030 ** The variable `recursive-load-depth-limit' has been deleted.
4031 Emacs now signals an error if the same file is loaded with more
4032 than 3 levels of nesting.
4033
4034 +++
4035 ** The function symbol-file can now search specifically for function or
4036 variable definitions.
4037
4038 +++
4039 ** `provide' and `featurep' now accept an optional second argument
4040 to test/provide subfeatures. Also `provide' now checks `after-load-alist'
4041 and runs any code associated with the provided feature.
4042
4043 +++
4044 ** `declare' is now a macro. This change was made mostly for
4045 documentation purposes and should have no real effect on Lisp code.
4046
4047 +++
4048 ** Byte compiler changes:
4049
4050 *** The byte-compiler now displays the actual line and character
4051 position of errors, where possible. Additionally, the form of its
4052 warning and error messages have been brought more in line with the
4053 output of other GNU tools.
4054
4055 *** The new macro `with-no-warnings' suppresses all compiler warnings
4056 inside its body. In terms of execution, it is equivalent to `progn'.
4057
4058 *** You can avoid warnings for possibly-undefined symbols with a
4059 simple convention that the compiler understands. (This is mostly
4060 useful in code meant to be portable to different Emacs versions.)
4061 Write forms like the following, or code that macroexpands into such
4062 forms:
4063
4064 (if (fboundp 'foo) <then> <else>)
4065 (if (boundp 'foo) <then> <else)
4066
4067 In the first case, using `foo' as a function inside the <then> form
4068 won't produce a warning if it's not defined as a function, and in the
4069 second case, using `foo' as a variable won't produce a warning if it's
4070 unbound. The test must be in exactly one of the above forms (after
4071 macro expansion), but such tests may be nested. Note that `when' and
4072 `unless' expand to `if', but `cond' doesn't.
4073
4074 *** `(featurep 'xemacs)' is treated by the compiler as nil. This
4075 helps to avoid noisy compiler warnings in code meant to run under both
4076 Emacs and XEmacs and may sometimes make the result significantly more
4077 efficient. Since byte code from recent versions of XEmacs won't
4078 generally run in Emacs and vice versa, this optimization doesn't lose
4079 you anything.
4080
4081 *** The local variable `no-byte-compile' in elisp files is now obeyed.
4082
4083 ---
4084 ** When a Lisp file uses CL functions at run-time, compiling the file
4085 now issues warnings about these calls, unless the file performs
4086 (require 'cl) when loaded.
4087
4088 +++
4089 ** New function unsafep returns nil if the given Lisp form can't possibly
4090 do anything dangerous; otherwise it returns a reason why the form might be
4091 unsafe (calls dangerous function, alters global variable, etc).
4092
4093 +++
4094 ** There is a new Warnings facility; see the functions `warn'
4095 and `display-warning'.
4096
4097 ---
4098 ** VC changes for backends:
4099 *** (vc-switches BACKEND OPERATION) is a new function for use by backends.
4100 *** The new `find-version' backend function replaces the `destfile'
4101 parameter of the `checkout' backend function.
4102 Old code still works thanks to a default `find-version' behavior that
4103 uses the old `destfile' parameter.
4104
4105 +++
4106 ** Already true in Emacs 21.1, but not emphasized clearly enough:
4107
4108 Multibyte buffers can now faithfully record all 256 character codes
4109 from 0 to 255. As a result, most of the past reasons to use unibyte
4110 buffers no longer exist. We only know of three reasons to use them
4111 now:
4112
4113 1. If you prefer to use unibyte text all of the time.
4114
4115 2. For reading files into temporary buffers, when you want to avoid
4116 the time it takes to convert the format.
4117
4118 3. For binary files where format conversion would be pointless and
4119 wasteful.
4120
4121 ---
4122 ** set-buffer-file-coding-system now takes an additional argument,
4123 NOMODIFY. If it is non-nil, it means don't mark the buffer modified.
4124
4125 +++
4126 ** The new variable `auto-coding-functions' lets you specify functions
4127 to examine a file being visited and deduce the proper coding system
4128 for it. (If the coding system is detected incorrectly for a specific
4129 file, you can put a `coding:' tags to override it.)
4130
4131 ---
4132 ** The new function `merge-coding-systems' fills in unspecified aspects
4133 of one coding system from another coding system.
4134
4135 ---
4136 ** New coding system property `mime-text-unsuitable' indicates that
4137 the coding system's `mime-charset' is not suitable for MIME text
4138 parts, e.g. utf-16.
4139
4140 +++
4141 ** New function `decode-coding-inserted-region' decodes a region as if
4142 it is read from a file without decoding.
4143
4144 +++
4145 ** Function `translate-region' accepts also a char-table as TABLE
4146 argument.
4147
4148 +++
4149 ** The new translation table `translation-table-for-input'
4150 is used for customizing self-insertion. The character to
4151 be inserted is translated through it.
4152
4153 ---
4154 ** New CCL functions `lookup-character' and `lookup-integer' access
4155 hash tables defined by the Lisp function `define-translation-hash-table'.
4156
4157 +++
4158 ** The flags, width, and precision options for %-specifications in function
4159 `format' are now documented. Some flags that were accepted but not
4160 implemented (such as "*") are no longer accepted.
4161
4162 ---
4163 ** New function `redirect-debugging-output' can be used to redirect
4164 debugging output on the stderr file handle to a file.
4165
4166 +++
4167 ** `makehash' is now obsolete. Use `make-hash-table' instead.
4168
4169 +++
4170 ** The macro `with-syntax-table' does not copy the table any more.
4171
4172 +++
4173 ** New variables `gc-elapsed' and `gcs-done' provide extra information
4174 on garbage collection.
4175
4176 +++
4177 ** New function `locale-info' accesses locale information.
4178
4179 +++
4180 ** The new variable `print-continuous-numbering', when non-nil, says
4181 that successive calls to print functions should use the same
4182 numberings for circular structure references. This is only relevant
4183 when `print-circle' is non-nil.
4184
4185 When you bind `print-continuous-numbering' to t, you should
4186 also bind `print-number-table' to nil.
4187
4188 ---
4189 ** When pure storage overflows while dumping, Emacs now prints how
4190 much pure storage it will approximately need.
4191
4192 +++
4193 ** File local variables.
4194
4195 A file local variables list cannot specify a string with text
4196 properties--any specified text properties are discarded.
4197
4198 +++
4199 ** The variable `safe-local-eval-forms' specifies a list of forms that
4200 are ok to evaluate when they appear in an `eval' local variables
4201 specification. Normally Emacs asks for confirmation before evaluating
4202 such a form, but if the form appears in this list, no confirmation is
4203 needed.
4204
4205 ---
4206 ** If a function has a non-nil `safe-local-eval-function' property,
4207 that means it is ok to evaluate some calls to that function when it
4208 appears in an `eval' local variables specification. If the property
4209 is t, then any form calling that function with constant arguments is
4210 ok. If the property is a function or list of functions, they are called
4211 with the form as argument, and if any returns t, the form is ok to call.
4212
4213 If the form is not "ok to call", that means Emacs asks for
4214 confirmation as before.
4215
4216 +++
4217 ** Renamed hooks to better follow the naming convention:
4218 find-file-hooks to find-file-hook,
4219 find-file-not-found-hooks to find-file-not-found-functions,
4220 write-file-hooks to write-file-functions,
4221 write-contents-hooks to write-contents-functions,
4222 x-lost-selection-hooks to x-lost-selection-functions,
4223 x-sent-selection-hooks to x-sent-selection-functions.
4224 Marked local-write-file-hooks as obsolete (use the LOCAL arg of `add-hook').
4225
4226 +++
4227 ** The new variable `delete-frame-functions' replaces `delete-frame-hook'.
4228 It was renamed to follow the naming conventions for abnormal hooks. The old
4229 name remains available as an alias, but has been marked obsolete.
4230
4231 +++
4232 ** The new function `file-remote-p' tests a file name and returns
4233 non-nil if it specifies a remote file (one that Emacs accesses using
4234 its own special methods and not directly through the file system).
4235 The value in that case is an identifier for the remote file system.
4236
4237 +++
4238 ** Functions `get' and `plist-get' no longer signals an error for
4239 a malformed property list. They also detect cyclic lists.
4240
4241 +++
4242 ** The function `atan' now accepts an optional second argument.
4243
4244 When called with 2 arguments, as in `(atan Y X)', `atan' returns the
4245 angle in radians between the vector [X, Y] and the X axis. (This is
4246 equivalent to the standard C library function `atan2'.)
4247
4248 +++
4249 ** New function format-mode-line.
4250
4251 This returns the mode-line or header-line of the selected (or a
4252 specified) window as a string with or without text properties.
4253
4254 +++
4255 ** The new mode-line construct `(:propertize ELT PROPS...)' can be
4256 used to add text properties to mode-line elements.
4257
4258 +++
4259 ** The new `%i' and `%I' constructs for `mode-line-format' can be used
4260 to display the size of the accessible part of the buffer on the mode
4261 line.
4262
4263 ---
4264 ** Indentation of simple and extended loop forms has been added to the
4265 cl-indent package. The new user options
4266 `lisp-loop-keyword-indentation', `lisp-loop-forms-indentation', and
4267 `lisp-simple-loop-indentation' can be used to customize the
4268 indentation of keywords and forms in loop forms.
4269
4270 ---
4271 ** Indentation of backquoted forms has been made customizable in the
4272 cl-indent package. See the new user option `lisp-backquote-indentation'.
4273
4274 +++
4275 ** field-beginning and field-end now accept an additional optional
4276 argument, LIMIT.
4277
4278 +++
4279 ** define-abbrev now accepts an optional argument SYSTEM-FLAG. If
4280 non-nil, this marks the abbrev as a "system" abbrev, which means that
4281 it won't be stored in the user's abbrevs file if he saves the abbrevs.
4282 Major modes that predefine some abbrevs should always specify this
4283 flag.
4284
4285 ---
4286 ** describe-vector now takes a second argument `describer' which is
4287 called to print the entries' values. It defaults to `princ'.
4288
4289 +++
4290 ** defcustom and other custom declarations now use a default group
4291 (the last prior group defined in the same file) when no :group was given.
4292
4293 ---
4294 ** The new customization type `float' specifies numbers with floating
4295 point (no integers are allowed).
4296
4297 +++
4298 ** emacsserver now runs pre-command-hook and post-command-hook when
4299 it receives a request from emacsclient.
4300
4301 ---
4302 ** New function `text-clone-create'. Text clones are chunks of text
4303 that are kept identical by transparently propagating changes from one
4304 clone to the other.
4305
4306 +++
4307 ** Functions `user-uid' and `user-real-uid' now return floats if the
4308 user UID doesn't fit in a Lisp integer. Function `user-full-name'
4309 accepts a float as UID parameter.
4310
4311 +++
4312 ** New vars `exec-suffixes' and `load-suffixes' used when
4313 searching for an executable resp. an elisp file.
4314
4315 +++
4316 ** Functions from `post-gc-hook' are run at the end of garbage
4317 collection. The hook is run with GC inhibited, so use it with care.
4318
4319 +++
4320 ** The variables most-positive-fixnum and most-negative-fixnum
4321 hold the largest and smallest possible integer values.
4322
4323 ---
4324 ** On MS Windows, locale-coding-system is used to interact with the OS.
4325 The Windows specific variable w32-system-coding-system, which was
4326 formerly used for that purpose is now an alias for locale-coding-system.
4327
4328 ---
4329 ** New function x-send-client-message sends a client message when
4330 running under X.
4331
4332 ---
4333 ** easy-mmode-define-global-mode has been renamed to
4334 define-global-minor-mode. The old name remains as an alias.
4335
4336 ---
4337 ** To manipulate the File menu using easy-menu, you must specify the
4338 proper name "file". In previous Emacs versions, you had to specify
4339 "files", even though the menu item itself was changed to say "File"
4340 several versions ago.
4341
4342 ---
4343 ** The dummy function keys made by easymenu are now always lower case.
4344 If you specify the menu item name "Ada", for instance, it uses `ada'
4345 as the "key" bound by that key binding.
4346
4347 This is relevant only if Lisp code looks for the bindings that were
4348 made with easymenu.
4349
4350 ---
4351 ** `easy-menu-define' now allows you to use nil for the symbol name
4352 if you don't need to give the menu a name. If you install the menu
4353 into other keymaps right away (MAPS is non-nil), it usually doesn't
4354 need to have a name.
4355
4356 ** New functions, macros, and commands:
4357
4358 +++
4359 *** The new function `assoc-string' replaces `assoc-ignore-case' and
4360 `assoc-ignore-representation', which are still available, but have
4361 been declared obsolete.
4362
4363 +++
4364 *** The new function `buffer-local-value' returns the buffer-local
4365 binding of VARIABLE (a symbol) in buffer BUFFER. If VARIABLE does not
4366 have a buffer-local binding in buffer BUFFER, it returns the default
4367 value of VARIABLE instead.
4368
4369 +++
4370 *** The new function `called-interactively-p' does what many people
4371 have mistakenly believed `interactive-p' did: it returns t if the
4372 calling function was called through `call-interactively'. This should
4373 only be used when you cannot add a new "interactive" argument to the
4374 command.
4375
4376 *** The new function copy-abbrev-table returns a new abbrev table that
4377 is a copy of a given abbrev table.
4378
4379 +++
4380 *** New function copy-tree makes a copy of a tree, recursively copying
4381 both cars and cdrs.
4382
4383 +++
4384 *** New function `delete-dups' destructively removes `equal'
4385 duplicates from a list. Of several `equal' occurrences of an element
4386 in the list, the first one is kept.
4387
4388 +++
4389 *** The new function `filter-buffer-substring' extracts a buffer
4390 substring, passes it through a set of filter functions, and returns
4391 the filtered substring. It is used instead of `buffer-substring' or
4392 `delete-and-extract-region' when copying text into a user-accessible
4393 data structure, like the kill-ring, X clipboard, or a register. The
4394 list of filter function is specified by the new variable
4395 `buffer-substring-filters'. For example, Longlines mode uses
4396 `buffer-substring-filters' to remove soft newlines from the copied
4397 text.
4398
4399 +++
4400 *** New functions frame-current-scroll-bars and window-current-scroll-bars.
4401
4402 These functions return the current locations of the vertical and
4403 horizontal scroll bars in a frame or window.
4404
4405 +++
4406 *** The new primitive `get-internal-run-time' returns the processor
4407 run time used by Emacs since start-up.
4408
4409 +++
4410 *** The new function insert-buffer-substring-as-yank works like
4411 `insert-buffer-substring', but removes the text properties in the
4412 `yank-excluded-properties' list.
4413
4414 +++
4415 *** The new function insert-buffer-substring-no-properties is like
4416 insert-buffer-substring, but removes all text properties from the
4417 inserted substring.
4418
4419 +++
4420 *** The new functions `lax-plist-get' and `lax-plist-put' are like
4421 `plist-get' and `plist-put', except that they compare the property
4422 name using `equal' rather than `eq'.
4423
4424 +++
4425 *** New function `line-number-at-pos' returns the line number of the
4426 current line in the current buffer, or if optional buffer position is
4427 given, line number of corresponding line in current buffer.
4428
4429 +++
4430 *** New function `looking-back' checks whether a regular expression matches
4431 the text before point. Specifying the LIMIT argument bounds how far
4432 back the match can start; this is a way to keep it from taking too long.
4433
4434 +++
4435 *** New function `macroexpand-all' expands all macros in a form.
4436 It is similar to the Common-Lisp function of the same name.
4437 One difference is that it guarantees to return the original argument
4438 if no expansion is done, which may be tested using `eq'.
4439
4440 *** The new function `minibufferp' returns non-nil if its optional
4441 buffer argument is a minibuffer. If the argument is omitted, it
4442 defaults to the current buffer.
4443
4444 +++
4445 *** New function minibuffer-selected-window returns the window which
4446 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4447
4448 +++
4449 *** The new function `modify-all-frames-parameters' modifies parameters
4450 for all (existing and future) frames.
4451
4452 +++
4453 *** New functions posn-at-point and posn-at-x-y return
4454 click-event-style position information for a given visible buffer
4455 position or for a given window pixel coordinate.
4456
4457 ---
4458 *** New function quail-find-key returns a list of keys to type in the
4459 current input method to input a character.
4460
4461 +++
4462 *** The new function `rassq-delete-all' deletes all elements from an
4463 alist whose cdr is `eq' to a specified value.
4464
4465 +++
4466 *** The new function remove-list-of-text-properties is almost the same
4467 as `remove-text-properties'. The only difference is that it takes a
4468 list of property names as argument rather than a property list.
4469
4470 +++
4471 *** The new primitive `set-file-times' sets a file's access and
4472 modification times. Magic file name handlers can handle this
4473 operation.
4474
4475 +++
4476 *** New function substring-no-properties returns a substring without
4477 text properties.
4478
4479 +++
4480 *** The new function syntax-after returns the syntax code
4481 of the character after a specified buffer position, taking account
4482 of text properties as well as the character code.
4483
4484 +++
4485 *** `syntax-class' extracts the class of a syntax code (as returned
4486 by syntax-after).
4487
4488 +++
4489 *** New function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu'
4490
4491 The `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' must not be used (as previously
4492 recommended) for making entries in the tool bar for local keymaps.
4493 Instead, use the function `tool-bar-local-item-from-menu', which lets
4494 you specify the map to use as an argument.
4495
4496 +++
4497 *** New function window-body-height.
4498 This is like window-height but does not count the mode line
4499 or the header line.
4500
4501 +++
4502 *** (while-no-input BODY...) runs BODY, but only so long as no input
4503 arrives. If the user types or clicks anything, BODY stops as if a
4504 quit had occurred. while-no-input returns the value of BODY, if BODY
4505 finishes. It returns nil if BODY was aborted.
4506
4507 +++
4508 *** New macro with-local-quit temporarily sets inhibit-quit to nil for use
4509 around potentially blocking or long-running code in timers
4510 and post-command-hooks.
4511
4512 ** New packages:
4513
4514 *** The new package syntax.el provides an efficient way to find the
4515 current syntactic context (as returned by parse-partial-sexp).
4516
4517 *** The new package bindat.el provides functions to unpack and pack
4518 binary data structures, such as network packets, to and from Lisp
4519 data structures.
4520
4521 ---
4522 *** The TCL package tcl-mode.el was replaced by tcl.el.
4523 This was actually done in Emacs-21.1, and was not documented.
4524
4525 +++
4526 *** The new package button.el implements simple and fast `clickable buttons'
4527 in emacs buffers. `buttons' are much lighter-weight than the `widgets'
4528 implemented by widget.el, and can be used by lisp code that doesn't
4529 require the full power of widgets. Emacs uses buttons for such things
4530 as help and apropos buffers.
4531
4532 ---
4533 *** master-mode.el implements a minor mode for scrolling a slave
4534 buffer without leaving your current buffer, the master buffer.
4535
4536 It can be used by sql.el, for example: the SQL buffer is the master
4537 and its SQLi buffer is the slave. This allows you to scroll the SQLi
4538 buffer containing the output from the SQL buffer containing the
4539 commands.
4540
4541 This is how to use sql.el and master.el together: the variable
4542 sql-buffer contains the slave buffer. It is a local variable in the
4543 SQL buffer.
4544
4545 (add-hook 'sql-mode-hook
4546 (function (lambda ()
4547 (master-mode t)
4548 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4549 (add-hook 'sql-set-sqli-hook
4550 (function (lambda ()
4551 (master-set-slave sql-buffer))))
4552
4553 +++
4554 *** New Lisp library testcover.el works with edebug to help you determine
4555 whether you've tested all your Lisp code. Function testcover-start
4556 instruments all functions in a given file. Then test your code. Function
4557 testcover-mark-all adds overlay "splotches" to the Lisp file's buffer to
4558 show where coverage is lacking. Command testcover-next-mark (bind it to
4559 a key!) will move point forward to the next spot that has a splotch.
4560
4561 Normally, a red splotch indicates the form was never completely
4562 evaluated; a brown splotch means it always evaluated to the same
4563 value. The red splotches are skipped for forms that can't possibly
4564 complete their evaluation, such as `error'. The brown splotches are
4565 skipped for forms that are expected to always evaluate to the same
4566 value, such as (setq x 14).
4567
4568 For difficult cases, you can add do-nothing macros to your code to
4569 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
4570 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
4571 return. The macro 1value suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
4572 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
4573 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
4574
4575 ---
4576 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
4577
4578 ---
4579 ** The function insert-string is now obsolete.
4580 \f
4581 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
4582
4583 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
4584 been added.
4585
4586 \f
4587 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
4588
4589 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
4590 with Custom.
4591
4592 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
4593 as mule-utf-8.
4594
4595 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
4596 in UTF-8 locales).
4597
4598 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
4599 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
4600 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
4601 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
4602 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
4603 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
4604 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
4605 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
4606 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
4607 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
4608
4609 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
4610 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
4611
4612 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
4613 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
4614 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
4615 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
4616 contrary to the compound text specification.
4617
4618 \f
4619 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
4620
4621 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
4622
4623 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
4624
4625 \f
4626 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
4627
4628 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
4629
4630 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
4631 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
4632 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
4633 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
4634 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
4635
4636 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
4637 were changed.
4638
4639 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
4640 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
4641
4642 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
4643 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
4644 instead of using default-major-mode.
4645
4646 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
4647 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
4648 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
4649 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
4650 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
4651 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
4652 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
4653
4654 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
4655 NEWS.
4656
4657 \f
4658 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
4659
4660 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
4661 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
4662 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
4663
4664 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
4665 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
4666
4667 \f
4668 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
4669
4670 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
4671 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
4672 charsets in this release.
4673
4674 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
4675
4676 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
4677
4678 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
4679 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
4680 to list them.
4681
4682 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
4683 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
4684 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
4685 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
4686 necessary changes to unexec.
4687
4688 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
4689 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
4690
4691 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
4692 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
4693
4694 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
4695 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
4696
4697 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
4698 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
4699 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
4700 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
4701 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
4702
4703 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
4704 new display features described below.
4705
4706 \f
4707 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
4708
4709 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
4710
4711 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
4712 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
4713 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
4714 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
4715 the text.
4716
4717 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
4718
4719 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
4720 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
4721 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
4722 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
4723 specify a font.
4724
4725 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
4726 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
4727 under Lisp changes, below.
4728
4729 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
4730
4731 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
4732 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
4733 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
4734 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
4735 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
4736 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
4737 on terminals.
4738
4739 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
4740 supported on character terminals.
4741
4742 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
4743 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
4744 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
4745 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
4746
4747 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
4748
4749 ** Sound support
4750
4751 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
4752 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
4753 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
4754 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
4755 sound support.
4756
4757 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
4758
4759 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
4760 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
4761 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
4762 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
4763
4764 - User option: max-mini-window-height
4765
4766 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
4767 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
4768 specifies a number of lines.
4769
4770 Default is 0.25.
4771
4772 - User option: resize-mini-windows
4773
4774 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
4775 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
4776 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
4777 again.
4778
4779 Default is `grow-only'.
4780
4781 ** LessTif support.
4782
4783 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
4784 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
4785
4786 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
4787
4788 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
4789 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
4790 non-nil.
4791
4792 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
4793
4794 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
4795 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
4796 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
4797
4798 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
4799
4800 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
4801 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
4802 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
4803 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
4804 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
4805 Emacs.
4806
4807 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
4808 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
4809 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
4810 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
4811 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
4812 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
4813
4814 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
4815 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
4816 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
4817 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
4818 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
4819 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
4820
4821 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
4822 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
4823 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
4824 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
4825 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
4826
4827 ** Tool bar support.
4828
4829 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
4830 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
4831 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
4832 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
4833 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
4834 icons will be used.
4835
4836 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
4837 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
4838
4839 ** Tooltips.
4840
4841 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
4842 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
4843 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
4844
4845 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
4846 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
4847 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
4848 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
4849
4850 ** Automatic Hscrolling
4851
4852 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
4853 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
4854 customized.
4855
4856 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
4857 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
4858 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
4859 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
4860 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
4861
4862 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
4863 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
4864 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
4865 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
4866 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
4867 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
4868
4869 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
4870 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
4871 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
4872 customizing face `fringe'.
4873
4874 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
4875 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
4876 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
4877 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
4878 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
4879 the window to be partially obscured.)
4880
4881 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
4882 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
4883 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
4884 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
4885
4886 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
4887
4888 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
4889 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
4890 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
4891 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
4892 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
4893 have enabled one.
4894
4895 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
4896
4897 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
4898
4899 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
4900
4901 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
4902 `*') toggles the status.
4903
4904 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
4905
4906 ** Hourglass pointer
4907
4908 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
4909 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
4910
4911 ** Blinking cursor
4912
4913 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
4914 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
4915 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
4916 the group `cursor'.
4917
4918 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
4919
4920 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
4921 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
4922 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
4923 details.
4924
4925 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
4926 have to do anything to activate it.
4927
4928 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
4929
4930 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
4931 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
4932
4933 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
4934 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
4935 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
4936 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
4937 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
4938 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
4939 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
4940 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
4941
4942 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
4943 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
4944 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
4945 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
4946 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
4947 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
4948
4949 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
4950 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
4951
4952 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
4953 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
4954 buffer by default.
4955
4956 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
4957 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
4958 beginning and end of the buffer.
4959
4960 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
4961 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
4962 signaled.
4963
4964 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
4965 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
4966
4967 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
4968 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
4969 this behavior.
4970
4971 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
4972 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
4973 Emacs dump core.
4974
4975 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
4976
4977 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
4978 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
4979 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
4980
4981 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
4982 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
4983 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
4984
4985 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
4986 using that menu.
4987
4988 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
4989
4990 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
4991 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
4992 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
4993 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
4994 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
4995 whitespace.
4996
4997 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
4998 all frames except the selected one.
4999
5000 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
5001 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
5002
5003 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
5004 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
5005 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
5006 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
5007 `Info-use-header-line'.
5008
5009 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
5010 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
5011 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
5012
5013 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
5014
5015 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
5016 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
5017 `fr-drdref.tex'.
5018
5019 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
5020 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
5021 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
5022 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
5023
5024 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
5025
5026 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
5027 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
5028 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
5029 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
5030
5031 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
5032 point in a pop-up window.
5033
5034 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
5035 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
5036 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
5037
5038 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
5039 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
5040
5041 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
5042 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
5043 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
5044 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
5045
5046 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
5047
5048 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
5049 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
5050
5051 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
5052 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
5053 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
5054
5055 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
5056 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
5057 non-nil.
5058
5059 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
5060 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
5061 file that is already visited under a different name.
5062
5063 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
5064 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
5065
5066 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
5067 and displays information about that.
5068
5069 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
5070 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
5071
5072 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
5073 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
5074 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
5075 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
5076 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
5077 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
5078
5079 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
5080 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
5081
5082 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
5083 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
5084 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
5085 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
5086 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
5087 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
5088 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
5089
5090 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
5091 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
5092
5093 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
5094 system for keyboard input.
5095
5096 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
5097 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
5098 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
5099 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
5100 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
5101 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
5102 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
5103 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
5104 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
5105
5106 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
5107 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
5108
5109 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
5110 displays all characters in that character set.
5111
5112 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
5113 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
5114
5115 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
5116 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
5117 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
5118
5119 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
5120 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
5121 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
5122 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
5123 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
5124 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
5125 and Polish `slash'.
5126
5127 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
5128 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
5129 of the tutorial.
5130
5131 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
5132 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
5133 Lisp Coding Convention".
5134
5135 new command old-binding
5136 --- ------- -----------
5137 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
5138 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
5139 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
5140
5141 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
5142 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
5143 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
5144
5145 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
5146 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
5147 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
5148 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
5149 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
5150 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
5151
5152 ** There are new Leim input methods.
5153 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
5154 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
5155 package.
5156
5157 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
5158 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
5159 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
5160 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
5161 "`", you must type "=q".
5162
5163 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
5164 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
5165 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
5166 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
5167 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
5168 on.
5169
5170 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
5171 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
5172 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
5173 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
5174
5175 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
5176 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
5177 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
5178 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
5179
5180 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
5181 on the display using several methods
5182
5183 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
5184 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
5185 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
5186
5187 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
5188 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
5189
5190 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
5191
5192 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
5193 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
5194
5195 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
5196 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
5197 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
5198 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
5199
5200 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
5201 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
5202 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
5203
5204 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
5205 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
5206
5207 ** New X resources recognized
5208
5209 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
5210 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
5211 is useful for debugging X problems.
5212
5213 Example:
5214
5215 emacs.synchronous: true
5216
5217 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
5218 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
5219 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
5220 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
5221 visual class names are
5222
5223 TrueColor
5224 PseudoColor
5225 DirectColor
5226 StaticColor
5227 GrayScale
5228 StaticGray
5229
5230 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
5231 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
5232 meaning.
5233
5234 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
5235 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
5236 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
5237 visual.
5238
5239 Example:
5240
5241 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
5242
5243 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
5244 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
5245 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
5246 resource values are `true' or `on'.
5247
5248 Example:
5249
5250 emacs.privateColormap: true
5251
5252 ** Faces and frame parameters.
5253
5254 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
5255 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
5256 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
5257 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
5258 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
5259 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
5260 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
5261
5262 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
5263 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
5264 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
5265 `default' face and vice versa.
5266
5267 ** New face `menu'.
5268
5269 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
5270
5271 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
5272
5273 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
5274 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
5275 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
5276 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
5277
5278 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
5279 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
5280 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
5281
5282 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
5283 `ScreenGamma'.
5284
5285 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
5286
5287 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
5288 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
5289 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
5290 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
5291
5292 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
5293
5294 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
5295
5296 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
5297
5298 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
5299 LessTif/Motif one.
5300
5301 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
5302 LessTif and Motif.
5303
5304 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
5305
5306 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
5307 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
5308 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
5309
5310 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
5311 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
5312
5313 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
5314 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
5315 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
5316
5317 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
5318
5319 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
5320 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
5321 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5322 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
5323
5324 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
5325 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
5326 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
5327 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
5328
5329 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
5330 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
5331 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
5332 buffers.
5333
5334 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
5335
5336 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
5337 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
5338 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
5339
5340 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
5341 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
5342 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
5343 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
5344 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
5345 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
5346
5347 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
5348
5349 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
5350 notably at the end of lines.
5351
5352 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
5353 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
5354
5355 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
5356
5357 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
5358 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
5359
5360 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
5361 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
5362 after each match to get the replacement text.
5363
5364 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
5365 you edit the replacement string.
5366
5367 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
5368 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
5369 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
5370
5371 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
5372
5373 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
5374 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
5375
5376 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
5377 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
5378 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
5379 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
5380
5381 --
5382 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
5383 read mail from the menu etc.
5384
5385 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
5386 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
5387 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
5388 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
5389
5390 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
5391 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
5392
5393 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
5394 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
5395 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
5396 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
5397 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
5398 of Emacs.
5399
5400 ** Customize changes
5401
5402 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
5403 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
5404 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
5405 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
5406 earlier versions of Emacs.
5407
5408 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
5409 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
5410 default).
5411
5412 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5413 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
5414 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
5415 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
5416 file.
5417
5418 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
5419 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
5420 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
5421 already in your init file.
5422
5423 ** New features in evaluation commands
5424
5425 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
5426 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
5427 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
5428 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
5429 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
5430
5431 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
5432 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
5433 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
5434 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
5435 printed).
5436
5437 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
5438 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
5439
5440 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
5441 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
5442
5443 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
5444 code when called with a prefix argument.
5445
5446 ** CC mode changes.
5447
5448 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
5449 current user setups (although it's believed that these
5450 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
5451 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
5452 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
5453 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
5454 release.
5455
5456 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
5457 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
5458 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
5459 confusion.
5460
5461 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
5462 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
5463 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
5464 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
5465
5466 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
5467 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
5468
5469 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
5470 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
5471
5472 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
5473 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
5474 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
5475 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
5476
5477 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
5478 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
5479 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
5480 earlier statement. An example:
5481
5482 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
5483 if (a[i])
5484 res += a[i]->offset;
5485 else
5486
5487 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
5488 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
5489 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
5490 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
5491 the preceding "if".
5492
5493 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
5494 by default.
5495
5496 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
5497 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
5498 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
5499 documentation or other natural language text.
5500
5501 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
5502 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
5503 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
5504 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
5505 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
5506 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
5507 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
5508
5509 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
5510 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
5511 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
5512 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
5513
5514 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
5515 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
5516 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
5517 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
5518 Pike mode only.
5519
5520 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
5521 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
5522 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
5523 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
5524 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
5525 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
5526 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
5527 is reported afterwards.
5528
5529 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
5530 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
5531 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
5532
5533 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
5534 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
5535 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
5536 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
5537 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
5538 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
5539 groundwork.
5540
5541 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
5542 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
5543 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
5544 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
5545 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
5546 have to bother.
5547
5548 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
5549 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
5550 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
5551 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
5552 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
5553 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
5554
5555 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
5556 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
5557 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
5558 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
5559 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
5560 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
5561 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
5562 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
5563
5564 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
5565 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
5566 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
5567 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
5568 above.
5569
5570 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
5571 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
5572 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
5573 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
5574 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
5575 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
5576 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
5577 function documentation for more info.
5578
5579 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
5580 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
5581 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
5582 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
5583 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
5584 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
5585 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
5586 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
5587
5588 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
5589
5590 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
5591 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
5592
5593 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
5594 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
5595 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
5596 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
5597 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
5598 style system.
5599
5600 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
5601 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
5602 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
5603 as far as possible.
5604
5605 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
5606 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
5607 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
5608 chapter about this in the manual.
5609
5610 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
5611 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
5612 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
5613 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
5614 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
5615
5616 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
5617 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
5618 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
5619
5620 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
5621 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
5622
5623 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
5624 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
5625 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
5626 inside CC Mode.
5627
5628 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
5629 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
5630 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
5631 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
5632 cc-mode/).
5633
5634 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
5635 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
5636 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
5637 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
5638 they were before the filling.
5639
5640 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
5641 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
5642 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
5643 literals.
5644
5645 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
5646 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
5647 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
5648 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
5649 this function.
5650
5651 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
5652 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
5653 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
5654 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
5655 Thanks to Eric Eide.
5656
5657 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
5658 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
5659 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
5660
5661 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
5662
5663 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
5664 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
5665 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
5666 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
5667
5668 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
5669 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
5670 the column specified by comment-column.
5671
5672 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
5673 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
5674 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
5675 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
5676 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
5677 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
5678
5679 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
5680 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
5681 arguments.
5682
5683 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
5684
5685 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
5686 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
5687 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
5688 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
5689 Provan).
5690
5691 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
5692
5693 ** Dired changes
5694
5695 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
5696 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
5697 is, delete only empty directories.
5698
5699 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
5700 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
5701 copy directories recursively.
5702
5703 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
5704 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
5705 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
5706
5707 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
5708 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
5709 directory.
5710
5711 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
5712 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
5713 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
5714 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
5715 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
5716
5717 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
5718 from ls switches.
5719
5720 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
5721 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
5722 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
5723 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
5724
5725 ** Gnus changes.
5726
5727 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
5728 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
5729 internationalization and mail-fetching.
5730
5731 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
5732 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
5733
5734 If you used procmail like in
5735
5736 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
5737 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
5738 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
5739 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
5740
5741 this now has changed to
5742
5743 (setq mail-sources
5744 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
5745 :suffix ".in")))
5746
5747 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
5748 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
5749
5750 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
5751 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
5752 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
5753 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
5754
5755 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
5756 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
5757 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
5758
5759 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
5760 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
5761 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
5762 now just a compatibility layer.
5763
5764 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
5765 Gnus facilities.
5766
5767 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
5768 called to position point.
5769
5770 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
5771 summary buffers and NOV files.
5772
5773 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
5774 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
5775
5776 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
5777 subtly different manner.
5778
5779 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
5780 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
5781 ever-changing layouts.
5782
5783 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
5784
5785 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
5786
5787 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
5788
5789 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
5790 macros
5791
5792 Key binding Macro
5793 -------------------------
5794 C-c C-c C-s @strong
5795 C-c C-c C-e @emph
5796 C-c C-c u @uref
5797 C-c C-c q @quotation
5798 C-c C-c m @email
5799 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
5800 M-RET @item
5801
5802 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
5803
5804 ** Changes in Outline mode.
5805
5806 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
5807 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
5808 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
5809
5810 ** Changes to Emacs Server
5811
5812 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
5813 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
5814 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
5815 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
5816 buffers to kill, as before.
5817
5818 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
5819 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
5820 this way.
5821
5822 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
5823 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
5824
5825 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
5826
5827 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
5828 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
5829 use. Default is 1000.
5830
5831 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
5832 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
5833
5834 ** Changes to hideshow.el
5835
5836 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
5837
5838 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
5839 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
5840 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
5841 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
5842
5843 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
5844 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
5845 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
5846 the open block.
5847
5848 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
5849 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
5850 the normal block-hiding function.
5851
5852 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
5853
5854 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
5855 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
5856 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
5857 for `hs-minor-mode'.
5858
5859 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
5860 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
5861
5862 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
5863
5864 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
5865 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
5866 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
5867
5868 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
5869 current buffer.
5870
5871 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
5872 in a log file.
5873
5874 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
5875 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
5876 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
5877 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
5878 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
5879 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
5880
5881 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
5882
5883 ** Changes to cmuscheme
5884
5885 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
5886 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
5887
5888 ** Changes in Font Lock
5889
5890 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
5891 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
5892
5893 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
5894 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
5895
5896 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
5897 the face used for each string/comment.
5898
5899 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
5900 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
5901
5902 ** Changes to Shell mode
5903
5904 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
5905 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
5906 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
5907 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
5908
5909 ** Comint (subshell) changes
5910
5911 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
5912 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
5913
5914 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
5915 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
5916 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
5917 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
5918 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
5919 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
5920
5921 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
5922 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
5923 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
5924 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
5925 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
5926 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
5927 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
5928 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
5929
5930 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
5931 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
5932
5933 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
5934 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
5935 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
5936
5937 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
5938 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
5939 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
5940
5941 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
5942 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
5943 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
5944
5945 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
5946 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
5947 argument, it appends to the file.
5948
5949 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
5950 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
5951 compatibility.
5952
5953 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
5954 ring (history).
5955
5956 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
5957 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
5958 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
5959
5960 ** Changes to Rmail mode
5961
5962 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
5963 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
5964 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
5965 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
5966 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
5967 as correspondent.
5968
5969 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
5970 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
5971 regexp matching your mail addresses.
5972
5973 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
5974 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
5975 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
5976 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
5977 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
5978
5979 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
5980 like `j'.
5981
5982 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
5983 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
5984 digest message.
5985
5986 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
5987 in which folder to put messages automatically.
5988
5989 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
5990 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
5991 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
5992
5993 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
5994 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
5995
5996 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
5997 use the -f option when sending mail.
5998
5999 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
6000 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
6001 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
6002 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
6003 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
6004 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
6005
6006 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
6007 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
6008 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
6009
6010 ** Changes to TeX mode
6011
6012 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
6013 `latex-mode'.
6014
6015 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
6016
6017 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
6018
6019 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
6020
6021 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
6022
6023 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
6024 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
6025 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
6026 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
6027 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
6028 can be edited from that buffer.
6029
6030 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
6031 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
6032 `A' to use all marked entries).
6033
6034 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
6035 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
6036
6037 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
6038 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
6039 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
6040 been cited.
6041
6042 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
6043 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
6044 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
6045 in column 1 are always made leaves.
6046
6047 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
6048 has the following new features:
6049
6050 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
6051 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
6052 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
6053 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
6054
6055 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
6056 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
6057 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
6058 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
6059 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
6060 defaults to 1.
6061
6062 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
6063 file names.
6064
6065 ** Ispell changes
6066
6067 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
6068 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
6069 spell-checks the current buffer.
6070
6071 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
6072 added.
6073
6074 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
6075 correction is made and re-checked.
6076
6077 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
6078
6079 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
6080 cases.
6081
6082 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
6083 on syntax errors.
6084
6085 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
6086 end of the buffer.
6087
6088 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6089
6090 ** Makefile mode changes
6091
6092 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
6093
6094 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
6095 Fontlock mode is active.
6096
6097 ** Isearch changes
6098
6099 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
6100 so that searches can be resumed.
6101
6102 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
6103 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
6104 that started the search.
6105
6106 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
6107 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
6108
6109 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
6110
6111 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
6112 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
6113 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
6114 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
6115 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
6116 `secondary-selection'.
6117
6118 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
6119 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
6120 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
6121 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
6122 usual snappy response.
6123
6124 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
6125 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
6126 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
6127 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
6128
6129 ** VC Changes
6130
6131 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
6132 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
6133 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
6134 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
6135 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
6136 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
6137 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
6138 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
6139 file is registered in that backend.
6140
6141 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
6142 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
6143 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
6144 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
6145 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
6146 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
6147
6148 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
6149 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
6150 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
6151 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
6152 where it doesn't make sense.)
6153
6154 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
6155 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
6156 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
6157
6158 *** General Changes
6159
6160 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
6161 checks are always done now.
6162
6163 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
6164 operations.
6165
6166 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
6167 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
6168 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
6169
6170 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
6171 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
6172 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
6173 the working file (``merge news'').
6174
6175 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6176 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
6177 downwards.
6178
6179 *** Multiple Backends
6180
6181 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
6182 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
6183 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
6184 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
6185 local RCS archives.
6186
6187 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
6188 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
6189 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
6190 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
6191
6192 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
6193 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
6194 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
6195 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
6196 current revision number from the more remote backend.
6197
6198 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
6199 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
6200 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
6201 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
6202
6203 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
6204 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
6205 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
6206 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
6207
6208 *** Changes for CVS
6209
6210 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
6211 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
6212 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
6213 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
6214 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
6215 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
6216 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
6217
6218 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
6219 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
6220 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
6221 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
6222 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
6223 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
6224 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
6225 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
6226 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
6227 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
6228 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
6229 name.)
6230
6231 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
6232 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
6233 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
6234 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
6235 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
6236 entire directory tree.
6237
6238 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
6239 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
6240 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
6241 "watched" by other developers.)
6242
6243 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
6244 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
6245 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
6246 starting at the given directory.
6247
6248 *** Lisp Changes in VC
6249
6250 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
6251 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
6252 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
6253 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
6254 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
6255 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
6256 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
6257 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
6258 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
6259
6260 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
6261 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
6262 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
6263 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
6264
6265 ** New modes and packages
6266
6267 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
6268 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
6269 the default is not applicable.
6270
6271 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
6272 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
6273 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
6274
6275 Features are:
6276
6277 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
6278 drawn, like this: | \ /
6279 --+-- X
6280 | / \
6281
6282 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
6283 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
6284 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
6285 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
6286 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
6287 you are drawing.
6288
6289 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
6290 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
6291
6292 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
6293 flood-filling.
6294
6295 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
6296 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
6297 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
6298 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
6299
6300 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
6301 also do without the mouse.
6302
6303 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
6304 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
6305 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
6306 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
6307 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
6308
6309 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
6310
6311 lines straight-lines
6312 rectangles squares
6313 poly-lines straight poly-lines
6314 ellipses circles
6315 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
6316 spray-can setting size for spraying
6317 vaporize line vaporize lines
6318 erase characters erase rectangles
6319
6320 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
6321 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
6322 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
6323 drawing.
6324
6325 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
6326 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
6327 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
6328 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
6329
6330 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
6331 can be turned off).
6332
6333 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
6334 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
6335 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
6336 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
6337 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
6338 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
6339 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
6340 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
6341 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
6342
6343 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
6344 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
6345 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
6346 on certain projects.
6347
6348 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
6349 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
6350
6351 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
6352
6353 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
6354 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
6355 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
6356 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
6357 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
6358 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
6359 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
6360 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
6361
6362 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
6363 Emacs is idle.
6364
6365 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
6366 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
6367
6368 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
6369 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
6370
6371 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
6372 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
6373 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
6374 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
6375 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
6376
6377 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
6378 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
6379 separate Texinfo file.
6380
6381 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
6382 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
6383 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
6384 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
6385 enter check-in log messages.
6386
6387 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
6388 without invoking external programs.
6389
6390 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
6391 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
6392 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
6393 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
6394 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
6395
6396 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
6397 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
6398
6399 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
6400 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
6401
6402 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
6403 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
6404 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
6405 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
6406 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
6407 single step.
6408
6409 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
6410 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
6411 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
6412 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
6413
6414 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
6415 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
6416 actually modifying content of a buffer.
6417
6418 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
6419 PostScript.
6420
6421 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
6422
6423 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
6424
6425 ; comment (until end of line)
6426 A non-terminal
6427 "C" terminal
6428 ?C? special
6429 $A default non-terminal
6430 $"C" default terminal
6431 $?C? default special
6432 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
6433 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
6434 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
6435 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
6436 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
6437 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
6438 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
6439 C+ one or more occurrences of C
6440 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
6441 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
6442 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
6443 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
6444 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
6445 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6446 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
6447
6448 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
6449
6450 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
6451 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
6452 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
6453 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
6454 equal signs of assignments.
6455
6456 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
6457 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
6458
6459 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
6460 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
6461 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
6462
6463 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
6464
6465 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
6466 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
6467 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
6468 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
6469 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
6470 which answers different needs.
6471
6472 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
6473 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
6474 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
6475 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
6476 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
6477 to be enabled.
6478
6479 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
6480 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
6481
6482 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
6483
6484 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
6485 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
6486 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
6487
6488 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
6489
6490 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
6491 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
6492 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
6493 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
6494 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
6495 and background colors.
6496
6497 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
6498 Pascal) language.
6499
6500 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
6501 the text at point.
6502
6503 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
6504
6505 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
6506
6507 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
6508 whitespace in a file.
6509
6510 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
6511 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
6512 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
6513 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
6514 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
6515 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
6516 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
6517
6518 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
6519
6520 Here is an example of columns:
6521
6522 horse apple bus
6523 dog pineapple car EXTRA
6524 porcupine strawberry airplane
6525
6526 Doing the following settings:
6527
6528 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
6529 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
6530 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
6531 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
6532
6533
6534 Selecting the lines above and typing:
6535
6536 M-x delimit-columns-region
6537
6538 It results:
6539
6540 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
6541 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
6542 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
6543
6544 delim-col has the following options:
6545
6546 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
6547 before all columns.
6548
6549 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
6550 between each column.
6551
6552 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
6553 after all columns.
6554
6555 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
6556 each column.
6557
6558 delim-col has the following commands:
6559
6560 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
6561 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
6562
6563 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
6564 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
6565 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
6566 recent file list can be displayed:
6567
6568 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
6569 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
6570 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
6571
6572 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
6573 dynamically change the menu appearance.
6574
6575 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
6576 text.
6577
6578 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
6579 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
6580 specific to Message mode.
6581
6582 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
6583 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
6584 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
6585
6586 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
6587 interface to access directory servers using different directory
6588 protocols. It has a separate manual.
6589
6590 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
6591 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
6592
6593 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
6594
6595 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
6596 minibuffer with completion.
6597
6598 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
6599 with the diary features.
6600
6601 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
6602 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
6603
6604 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
6605 Fill mode.
6606
6607 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
6608 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
6609 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
6610 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
6611
6612 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
6613 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
6614 `.g'.
6615
6616 ** Changes in sort.el
6617
6618 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
6619 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
6620 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
6621 numeric base.
6622
6623 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
6624
6625 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
6626 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
6627 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
6628
6629 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
6630 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
6631
6632 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
6633 output ^M at the end of lines.
6634
6635 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
6636 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
6637
6638 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
6639 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
6640 `(msb-mode 1)'.
6641
6642 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
6643 group.
6644
6645 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
6646 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
6647 are recognized:
6648
6649 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
6650 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
6651 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
6652 nil -- just delete one character.
6653
6654 Default value is `untabify'.
6655
6656 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
6657
6658 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
6659 symbol, not double-quoted.
6660
6661 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
6662 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
6663 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
6664 moved to lisp/obsolete.
6665
6666 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
6667 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
6668 `auto-compression-mode' command.
6669
6670 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
6671 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
6672 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
6673
6674 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
6675 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
6676
6677 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
6678 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
6679
6680 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
6681 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
6682
6683 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
6684 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
6685 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
6686 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
6687 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
6688 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
6689
6690 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
6691 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
6692
6693 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
6694
6695 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
6696 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
6697
6698 ** Shell script mode changes.
6699
6700 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
6701 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
6702 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
6703
6704 ** Etags changes.
6705
6706 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
6707
6708 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
6709 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
6710 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
6711 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
6712 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
6713
6714 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
6715 declarations when given the --declarations option.
6716
6717 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
6718 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
6719
6720 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
6721 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
6722 `template' keywords.
6723
6724 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
6725 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
6726
6727 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
6728 types.
6729
6730 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
6731
6732 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
6733
6734 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
6735 are now tagged.
6736
6737 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
6738
6739 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
6740 variables are tagged.
6741
6742 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
6743
6744 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
6745 for PSWrap.
6746
6747 ** Changes in etags.el
6748
6749 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
6750 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
6751 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
6752
6753 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
6754 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
6755
6756 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
6757 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
6758 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
6759 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
6760
6761 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
6762
6763 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
6764 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
6765
6766 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
6767
6768 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
6769 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
6770 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
6771
6772 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
6773 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
6774
6775 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
6776 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
6777
6778 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
6779 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
6780 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
6781 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
6782 point will go to the beginning of the file.
6783
6784 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
6785 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
6786 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
6787
6788 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
6789 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
6790 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
6791
6792 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
6793 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
6794 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
6795
6796 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
6797
6798 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
6799
6800 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
6801 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
6802 expression from that list, are not checked.
6803
6804 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
6805 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
6806 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
6807 the buffer, just like for the local files.
6808
6809 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
6810
6811 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
6812 displays local abbrevs, only.
6813
6814 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
6815 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
6816
6817 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
6818 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
6819 is measured in pixels.
6820
6821 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
6822 to be visited as images.
6823
6824 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
6825 were added to compile.el.
6826
6827 ** Withdrawn packages
6828
6829 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
6830 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
6831
6832 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
6833
6834 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
6835
6836 \f
6837 * Incompatible Lisp changes
6838
6839 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
6840 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
6841 See the sections below for details.
6842
6843 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
6844 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
6845 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
6846 to remove the properties of the copy.
6847
6848 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
6849 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
6850 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
6851 these properties are active.
6852
6853 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
6854 ranges may affect some code.
6855
6856 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
6857 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
6858 make a difference to some code.
6859
6860 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
6861 operates on the minibuffer.
6862
6863 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
6864 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
6865 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
6866 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
6867 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
6868 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
6869 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
6870 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
6871 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
6872 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
6873 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
6874 the buffer as multibyte characters.
6875
6876 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
6877 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
6878 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
6879
6880 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
6881 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
6882 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
6883
6884 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
6885 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
6886 such as `mapconcat'.
6887
6888 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
6889 string.
6890
6891 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
6892 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
6893 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
6894 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
6895 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
6896 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
6897 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
6898 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
6899
6900 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
6901 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
6902 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
6903 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
6904 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
6905 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
6906 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
6907 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
6908 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
6909 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
6910
6911 \f
6912 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
6913 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
6914
6915 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
6916
6917 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
6918 allows the animated display of strings.
6919
6920 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
6921 interactive form of a function.
6922
6923 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
6924 between custom options. Example:
6925
6926 (defcustom default-input-method nil
6927 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
6928 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
6929 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
6930 :group 'mule
6931 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
6932 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
6933
6934 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
6935 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
6936 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
6937
6938 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
6939 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
6940 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
6941 (signal or normal termination).
6942
6943 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
6944 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
6945
6946 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6947 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6948
6949 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
6950 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
6951
6952 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
6953
6954 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
6955 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
6956 being deleted.
6957
6958 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
6959
6960 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
6961 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
6962 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
6963 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
6964 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
6965 charset.
6966
6967 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
6968 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
6969 message.
6970
6971 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
6972 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
6973
6974 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
6975 with the more general `:mask' property.
6976
6977 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
6978
6979 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
6980 backslash.
6981
6982 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
6983 is running in batch mode. For example,
6984
6985 (message "%s" (read t))
6986
6987 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
6988 to standard output.
6989
6990 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
6991 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
6992
6993 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
6994 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
6995 frame or window.
6996
6997 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
6998 were added
6999
7000 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
7001
7002 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
7003 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
7004
7005 - Function: remq ELT LIST
7006
7007 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
7008 comparison is done with `eq'.
7009
7010 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
7011
7012 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
7013 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
7014 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
7015
7016 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
7017 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
7018 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
7019
7020 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
7021 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
7022
7023 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
7024 function was declared obsolete.
7025
7026 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
7027 retained as an alias).
7028
7029 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
7030 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
7031
7032 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
7033
7034 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
7035
7036 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
7037 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
7038 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
7039 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
7040 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
7041 means never include the minibuffer window.
7042
7043 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
7044
7045 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
7046
7047 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
7048
7049 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
7050 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
7051 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
7052 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
7053 returned.
7054
7055 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
7056 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
7057 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
7058 minibuffer even if it is active.
7059
7060 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
7061 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
7062 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
7063 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
7064 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
7065 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
7066
7067 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
7068 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
7069 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
7070 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
7071 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
7072 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
7073 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
7074
7075 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
7076 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
7077 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
7078
7079 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
7080 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
7081 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
7082 Default value is nil.
7083
7084 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
7085 meaning no limit.
7086
7087 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
7088 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
7089 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
7090
7091 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
7092 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
7093 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
7094
7095 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
7096 list of a primitive.
7097
7098 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
7099
7100 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
7101 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
7102 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
7103 than replacing the local map.
7104
7105 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
7106 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
7107 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
7108 instead.
7109
7110 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
7111
7112 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
7113 as promised long ago.
7114
7115 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
7116
7117 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
7118 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
7119 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
7120
7121 \f
7122 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
7123
7124 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
7125 regular expressions.
7126
7127 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
7128
7129 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7130
7131 - Macro: rx SEXP
7132
7133 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
7134
7135 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
7136 notation.
7137
7138 STRING
7139 matches string STRING literally.
7140
7141 CHAR
7142 matches character CHAR literally.
7143
7144 `not-newline'
7145 matches any character except a newline.
7146 .
7147 `anything'
7148 matches any character
7149
7150 `(any SET)'
7151 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
7152 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
7153
7154 '(in SET)'
7155 like `any'.
7156
7157 `(not (any SET))'
7158 matches any character not in SET
7159
7160 `line-start'
7161 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
7162 in the text being matched
7163
7164 `line-end'
7165 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
7166
7167 `string-start'
7168 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7169 string being matched against.
7170
7171 `string-end'
7172 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7173 string being matched against.
7174
7175 `buffer-start'
7176 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
7177 buffer being matched against.
7178
7179 `buffer-end'
7180 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
7181 buffer being matched against.
7182
7183 `point'
7184 matches the empty string, but only at point.
7185
7186 `word-start'
7187 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7188 word.
7189
7190 `word-end'
7191 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
7192
7193 `word-boundary'
7194 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
7195 word.
7196
7197 `(not word-boundary)'
7198 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
7199 word.
7200
7201 `digit'
7202 matches 0 through 9.
7203
7204 `control'
7205 matches ASCII control characters.
7206
7207 `hex-digit'
7208 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7209
7210 `blank'
7211 matches space and tab only.
7212
7213 `graphic'
7214 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7215 space, and DEL.
7216
7217 `printing'
7218 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7219 and DEL.
7220
7221 `alphanumeric'
7222 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7223 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7224
7225 `letter'
7226 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7227 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7228
7229 `ascii'
7230 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7231
7232 `nonascii'
7233 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7234
7235 `lower'
7236 matches anything lower-case.
7237
7238 `upper'
7239 matches anything upper-case.
7240
7241 `punctuation'
7242 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7243 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7244
7245 `space'
7246 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7247
7248 `word'
7249 matches anything that has word syntax.
7250
7251 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
7252 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
7253 of the following symbols.
7254
7255 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
7256 `punctuation' (\\s.)
7257 `word' (\\sw)
7258 `symbol' (\\s_)
7259 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
7260 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
7261 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
7262 `string-quote' (\\s\")
7263 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
7264 `escape' (\\s\\)
7265 `character-quote' (\\s/)
7266 `comment-start' (\\s<)
7267 `comment-end' (\\s>)
7268
7269 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
7270 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
7271
7272 `(category CATEGORY)'
7273 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
7274 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
7275
7276 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
7277 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
7278 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
7279 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
7280 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
7281 `symbol' (\\c5)
7282 `digit' (\\c6)
7283 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
7284 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
7285 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
7286 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
7287 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
7288 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
7289 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
7290 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
7291 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
7292 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
7293 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
7294 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
7295 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
7296 `ascii' (\\ca)
7297 `arabic' (\\cb)
7298 `chinese' (\\cc)
7299 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
7300 `greek' (\\cg)
7301 `korean' (\\ch)
7302 `indian' (\\ci)
7303 `japanese' (\\cj)
7304 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
7305 `latin' (\\cl)
7306 `lao' (\\co)
7307 `tibetan' (\\cq)
7308 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
7309 `thai' (\\ct)
7310 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
7311 `hebrew' (\\cw)
7312 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
7313 `can-break' (\\c|)
7314
7315 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
7316 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
7317
7318 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7319 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
7320
7321 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7322 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
7323 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
7324
7325 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7326 another name for `submatch'.
7327
7328 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
7329 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
7330 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
7331 regular expression.
7332
7333 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
7334 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
7335 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
7336 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
7337 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
7338
7339 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
7340 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
7341
7342 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
7343 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7344
7345 `(0+ SEXP)'
7346 like `zero-or-more'.
7347
7348 `(* SEXP)'
7349 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7350
7351 `(*? SEXP)'
7352 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7353
7354 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
7355 matches one or more occurrences of A.
7356
7357 `(1+ SEXP)'
7358 like `one-or-more'.
7359
7360 `(+ SEXP)'
7361 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7362
7363 `(+? SEXP)'
7364 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7365
7366 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
7367 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
7368
7369 `(optional SEXP)'
7370 like `zero-or-one'.
7371
7372 `(? SEXP)'
7373 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
7374
7375 `(?? SEXP)'
7376 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
7377
7378 `(repeat N SEXP)'
7379 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7380
7381 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
7382 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
7383
7384 `(eval FORM)'
7385 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
7386 `regexp-quote' it.
7387
7388 `(regexp REGEXP)'
7389 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
7390
7391 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
7392
7393 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
7394 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
7395 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
7396 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
7397
7398 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
7399 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
7400 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
7401 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
7402
7403 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
7404 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
7405 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
7406
7407 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
7408 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
7409 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
7410 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
7411 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
7412 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
7413 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
7414 eight-bit-graphic.
7415
7416 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
7417
7418 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
7419 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
7420 character set as previously.
7421
7422 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
7423 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
7424 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
7425
7426 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
7427 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
7428 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
7429 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
7430
7431 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
7432 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
7433
7434 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
7435 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
7436 "fontset-default".
7437
7438 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
7439 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
7440
7441 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
7442 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
7443 buffers and strings.
7444
7445 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
7446 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
7447 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
7448 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
7449 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
7450 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
7451 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
7452 also been deleted.
7453
7454 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
7455 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
7456 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
7457
7458 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
7459 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
7460 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
7461 may differ between buffer and string text.
7462
7463 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
7464 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
7465
7466 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
7467 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
7468 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
7469 `composition' from STRING.
7470
7471 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
7472 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
7473
7474 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
7475 obsolete.
7476
7477 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
7478 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
7479
7480 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
7481 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
7482 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
7483 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
7484
7485 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
7486 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
7487 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
7488 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
7489 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
7490 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
7491
7492 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
7493 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
7494 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
7495
7496 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
7497 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
7498 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
7499
7500 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
7501 have been introduced.
7502
7503 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7504 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
7505 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
7506 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
7507 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
7508 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
7509 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
7510 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
7511 their multibyte equivalent.
7512
7513 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
7514 that offset in the file before writing.
7515
7516 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
7517 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
7518
7519 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
7520 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
7521 from which the command was issued.
7522
7523 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
7524 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
7525 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
7526 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
7527 operate on.
7528
7529 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
7530 to `window-buffer-height'.
7531
7532 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
7533
7534 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
7535 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
7536 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
7537
7538 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
7539 respectively.
7540
7541 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
7542 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
7543
7544 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
7545 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
7546 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
7547
7548 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
7549 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
7550 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
7551 is currently displayed in some window.
7552
7553 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
7554 argument function's results.
7555
7556 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
7557 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
7558 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
7559 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
7560 sequence).
7561
7562 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
7563 header in the list of headers passed to it.
7564
7565 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
7566 ignores differences in case and text representation.
7567
7568 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
7569 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
7570 as follows:
7571
7572 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
7573 nil don't display a cursor
7574 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
7575 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
7576 others display a box cursor.
7577
7578 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
7579 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
7580 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
7581 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
7582
7583 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
7584 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
7585 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
7586 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
7587
7588 Example:
7589
7590 (string-to-syntax "()")
7591 => (4 . 41)
7592
7593 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
7594 other than 10.
7595
7596 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
7597 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
7598
7599 #b1111
7600 => 15
7601 #b-1111
7602 => -15
7603
7604 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
7605
7606 #o666
7607 => 438
7608
7609 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
7610
7611 #xbeef
7612 => 48815
7613
7614 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
7615
7616 #2R-111
7617 => -7
7618 #25rah
7619 => 267
7620
7621 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
7622 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
7623 and isn't a string.
7624
7625 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
7626 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
7627 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
7628 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
7629
7630 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
7631
7632 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
7633 for a regexp in a string.
7634
7635 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
7636 `mouse-position-function'.
7637
7638 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
7639 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
7640
7641 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
7642 Keywords are now always considered constants.
7643
7644 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
7645 returns it.
7646
7647 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
7648 returned by function `recent-keys'.
7649
7650 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
7651 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
7652 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
7653 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
7654 mode.
7655
7656 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
7657 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
7658
7659 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
7660 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
7661 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
7662 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
7663 been performed."
7664
7665 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
7666 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
7667 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
7668 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
7669
7670 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
7671 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
7672 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
7673
7674 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
7675 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
7676 specified table.
7677
7678 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
7679
7680 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
7681 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
7682 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
7683 what BODY returns.
7684
7685 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
7686 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
7687 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
7688 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
7689 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
7690
7691 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
7692 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
7693
7694 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
7695 instead of being optional.
7696
7697 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
7698 modify read-only text.
7699
7700 ** New functions and variables for locales.
7701
7702 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
7703 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
7704 time functions like strftime. The new variables
7705 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
7706 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
7707
7708 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
7709 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
7710 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
7711 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
7712 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
7713 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
7714 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
7715
7716 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
7717 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
7718 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
7719 start sequences.
7720
7721 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
7722 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
7723
7724 ** New function `propertize'
7725
7726 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
7727 strings with text properties.
7728
7729 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
7730
7731 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
7732 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
7733 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
7734 specified value of that property. Example:
7735
7736 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
7737
7738 ** push and pop macros.
7739
7740 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
7741 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
7742 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
7743
7744 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
7745 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
7746 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
7747
7748 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
7749
7750 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
7751 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
7752
7753 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
7754 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
7755 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
7756 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7757
7758 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
7759 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
7760 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
7761 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
7762
7763 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
7764 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
7765 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
7766 or a sign.
7767
7768 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
7769 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
7770 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
7771 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
7772 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
7773 space, and DEL.
7774 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
7775 and DEL.
7776 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
7777 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7778 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7779 [:alpha:] matches letters.
7780 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7781 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
7782 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
7783 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
7784 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
7785 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
7786 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
7787 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
7788 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
7789 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
7790 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
7791
7792 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
7793
7794 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
7795
7796 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
7797
7798 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
7799 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
7800
7801 :test TEST
7802
7803 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
7804 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
7805 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
7806
7807 :size SIZE
7808
7809 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
7810 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
7811
7812 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
7813
7814 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
7815 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
7816 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
7817 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
7818 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
7819
7820 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
7821
7822 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
7823 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
7824 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
7825
7826 :weakness WEAK
7827
7828 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
7829 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
7830 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
7831 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
7832 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
7833
7834 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
7835
7836 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
7837
7838 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
7839
7840 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
7841
7842 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
7843
7844 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
7845 values are shared.
7846
7847 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
7848
7849 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
7850
7851 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7852
7853 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
7854
7855 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
7856
7857 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
7858
7859 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
7860
7861 Returns the size of TABLE.
7862
7863 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
7864
7865 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
7866
7867 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
7868
7869 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
7870
7871 - Function: clrhash TABLE
7872
7873 Clear TABLE.
7874
7875 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
7876
7877 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
7878 not found.
7879
7880 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
7881
7882 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
7883 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
7884
7885 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
7886
7887 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
7888
7889 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
7890
7891 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
7892 arguments KEY and VALUE.
7893
7894 - Function: sxhash OBJ
7895
7896 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
7897
7898 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
7899
7900 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
7901 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
7902 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
7903 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
7904 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
7905
7906 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
7907
7908 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
7909 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
7910 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
7911
7912 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
7913 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
7914
7915 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
7916 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
7917
7918 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
7919 (sxhash (upcase a)))
7920
7921 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
7922 'case-fold-string-hash))
7923
7924 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
7925
7926 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
7927
7928 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
7929 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
7930 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
7931
7932 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
7933
7934 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
7935 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
7936
7937 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
7938 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
7939 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
7940 is too short to reach that column.
7941
7942 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
7943 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
7944 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
7945 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
7946
7947 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
7948 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
7949 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
7950
7951 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
7952 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
7953
7954 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
7955 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
7956
7957 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
7958 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
7959 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
7960 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
7961 temporary-file-directory instead.
7962
7963 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
7964 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
7965 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
7966 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
7967
7968 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
7969 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
7970
7971 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
7972
7973 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
7974 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
7975 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
7976
7977 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
7978
7979 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
7980 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
7981 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
7982 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
7983 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
7984 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
7985
7986 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
7987 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
7988 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
7989 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
7990
7991 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
7992
7993 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
7994 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
7995 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
7996 result string.
7997
7998 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
7999 string where arguments appear in the result string.
8000
8001 Example:
8002
8003 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
8004 (s2 "world"))
8005 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
8006 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
8007 (format s1 s2))
8008
8009 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
8010
8011 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
8012
8013 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
8014 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
8015 argument in it.
8016
8017 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
8018 (arg "world"))
8019 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
8020 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
8021 (message msg arg))
8022
8023 ** Sound support
8024
8025 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
8026 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
8027
8028 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
8029 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
8030 to enable sound support.
8031
8032 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
8033 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
8034 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
8035 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
8036 sound to play, before playing the sound.
8037
8038 The following sound properties are supported:
8039
8040 - `:file FILE'
8041
8042 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
8043 searched relative to `data-directory'.
8044
8045 - `:data DATA'
8046
8047 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
8048 may be present, but not both.
8049
8050 - `:volume VOLUME'
8051
8052 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
8053 0..1. This property is optional.
8054
8055 - `:device DEVICE'
8056
8057 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
8058 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
8059
8060 Other properties are ignored.
8061
8062 An alternative interface is called as
8063 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
8064
8065 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
8066
8067 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
8068 a keyword symbol.
8069
8070 ** Changes to garbage collection
8071
8072 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
8073 of live and free strings.
8074
8075 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
8076 strings that have been consed so far.
8077
8078 \f
8079 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
8080 Lisp Manual
8081
8082 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
8083 mini-windows.
8084
8085 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
8086 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
8087 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
8088
8089 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
8090
8091 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
8092
8093 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
8094 image.
8095
8096 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
8097
8098 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
8099
8100 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
8101 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
8102 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
8103 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
8104 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
8105
8106 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
8107 has a mask bitmap.
8108
8109 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
8110
8111 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
8112 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
8113 or omitted means use the selected frame.
8114
8115 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
8116 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
8117
8118 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
8119 optional.
8120
8121 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
8122 below).
8123
8124 \f
8125 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
8126
8127 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
8128 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
8129
8130 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
8131 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
8132 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
8133 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
8134 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
8135 just display it black instead.
8136
8137 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
8138 a line like
8139
8140 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
8141
8142 in your `.emacs'.
8143
8144 ** New face implementation.
8145
8146 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
8147 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
8148
8149 *** New faces.
8150
8151 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
8152
8153 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
8154
8155 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
8156 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
8157
8158 3. Font height in 1/10pt
8159
8160 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
8161
8162 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
8163
8164 6. Foreground color.
8165
8166 7. Background color.
8167
8168 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
8169
8170 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
8171
8172 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
8173
8174 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
8175
8176 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
8177 color.
8178
8179 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
8180 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
8181
8182 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
8183 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
8184 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
8185 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
8186 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
8187 attributes mentioned above.
8188
8189 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
8190 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
8191 created frames.
8192
8193 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
8194 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
8195 `fully-specified'.
8196
8197 *** Face merging.
8198
8199 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
8200 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
8201 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
8202 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
8203 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
8204 results in a fully-specified face.
8205
8206 *** Face realization.
8207
8208 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
8209 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
8210 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
8211 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
8212 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
8213 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
8214
8215 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
8216 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
8217 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
8218 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
8219
8220 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
8221 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
8222 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
8223 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
8224 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
8225
8226 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
8227 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
8228 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
8229 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
8230 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
8231 Emacs.
8232
8233 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
8234 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
8235 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
8236 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
8237
8238 **** Clearing face caches.
8239
8240 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
8241 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
8242 unused fonts.
8243
8244 *** Font selection.
8245
8246 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
8247 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
8248 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
8249
8250 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
8251 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
8252 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
8253 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
8254 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
8255
8256 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
8257 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
8258 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
8259
8260 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
8261
8262 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
8263 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
8264 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
8265 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
8266 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
8267 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
8268 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
8269
8270 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8271 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
8272 doesn't exist.
8273
8274 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
8275 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
8276 registry.
8277
8278 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
8279 slightly different.
8280
8281 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
8282
8283
8284 **** Scalable fonts
8285
8286 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
8287 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
8288 servers.
8289
8290 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
8291 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
8292 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
8293 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
8294 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
8295 that list. Example:
8296
8297 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
8298
8299 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
8300
8301 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
8302
8303 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
8304
8305 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
8306 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
8307 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
8308
8309 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
8310 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
8311 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
8312 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
8313 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
8314 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
8315 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
8316 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
8317 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
8318 of the face font sort order.
8319
8320 - Function: x-font-family-list
8321
8322 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
8323 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
8324 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
8325 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
8326
8327 - Variable: font-list-limit
8328
8329 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
8330 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
8331 matching font. The default is currently 100.
8332
8333 *** Setting face attributes.
8334
8335 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
8336 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
8337 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
8338 `face-attribute'.
8339
8340 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
8341 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
8342
8343 The following attributes are recognized:
8344
8345 `:family'
8346
8347 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
8348 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
8349 and `?' are allowed.
8350
8351 `:width'
8352
8353 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
8354 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
8355 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
8356 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
8357
8358 `:height'
8359
8360 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
8361 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
8362 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
8363 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
8364
8365 `:weight'
8366
8367 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
8368 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
8369 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
8370
8371 `:slant'
8372
8373 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
8374 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
8375 `reverse-oblique'.
8376
8377 `:foreground', `:background'
8378
8379 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
8380
8381 `:underline'
8382
8383 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
8384 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
8385 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
8386 don't underline.
8387
8388 `:overline'
8389
8390 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
8391 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
8392 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
8393 overline.
8394
8395 `:strike-through'
8396
8397 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
8398 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
8399 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
8400 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
8401
8402 `:box'
8403
8404 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
8405 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
8406 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
8407 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
8408 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
8409 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
8410 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
8411 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
8412 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
8413 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
8414 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
8415 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
8416 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
8417 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
8418 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
8419 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
8420 box.
8421
8422 `:inverse-video'
8423
8424 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
8425 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
8426
8427 `:stipple'
8428
8429 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
8430 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
8431 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
8432 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
8433 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
8434 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
8435
8436 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
8437 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
8438
8439 `:font'
8440
8441 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
8442 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
8443 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
8444 versions of Emacs.
8445
8446 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
8447 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
8448 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
8449
8450 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
8451 `defface'.
8452
8453 `:inherit'
8454
8455 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
8456 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
8457 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
8458
8459 *** Face attributes and X resources
8460
8461 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
8462 from X resources:
8463
8464 Face attribute X resource class
8465 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
8466 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
8467 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
8468 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
8469 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
8470 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
8471 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
8472 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
8473 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
8474 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
8475 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
8476 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
8477 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
8478 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
8479 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
8480 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
8481 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8482 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
8483 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
8484 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
8485
8486 *** Text property `face'.
8487
8488 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
8489 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
8490 specification can be
8491
8492 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
8493
8494 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
8495 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
8496 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
8497 for face attribute names.
8498
8499 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
8500 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
8501 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
8502
8503 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
8504
8505 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
8506 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
8507 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
8508 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
8509 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
8510 used to clear the mapping table.
8511
8512 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
8513
8514 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
8515 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
8516 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
8517 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
8518 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
8519 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
8520 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
8521 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
8522 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
8523 modify their color-related behavior.
8524
8525 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
8526 any frame type.
8527
8528 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
8529
8530 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
8531 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
8532 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
8533 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
8534 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
8535 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
8536 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
8537 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
8538 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
8539
8540 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
8541 display can display image files.
8542
8543 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
8544
8545 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
8546 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
8547 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
8548 `Inviolable' option.
8549
8550 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
8551 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
8552 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
8553
8554 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
8555
8556 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
8557 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
8558 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
8559
8560 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
8561 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
8562 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
8563 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
8564 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
8565 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
8566 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
8567 functions.
8568
8569 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
8570 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
8571 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
8572
8573 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
8574
8575 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
8576
8577 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
8578
8579 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8580 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
8581 constrained position if that is different.
8582
8583 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
8584 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
8585 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
8586 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
8587 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8588 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
8589 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
8590 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
8591 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
8592
8593 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
8594 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
8595 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
8596 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
8597 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
8598
8599 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
8600 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
8601
8602 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
8603
8604 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
8605
8606 Delete the field surrounding POS.
8607 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8608 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8609
8610 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8611
8612 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
8613 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8614 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8615 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
8616 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
8617
8618 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
8619
8620 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
8621 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8622 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8623 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
8624 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
8625
8626 - Function: field-string &optional POS
8627
8628 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
8629 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8630 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8631
8632 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
8633
8634 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
8635 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
8636 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
8637
8638 ** Image support.
8639
8640 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
8641 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
8642 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
8643 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
8644
8645 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
8646 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
8647 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
8648 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
8649 area.
8650
8651 IMAGE is an image specification.
8652
8653 *** Image specifications
8654
8655 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
8656 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
8657 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
8658 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
8659 described below are ignored.
8660
8661 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
8662
8663 `:ascent ASCENT'
8664
8665 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
8666 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
8667 to use for its ascent.
8668
8669 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
8670 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
8671
8672 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
8673 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
8674 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
8675 overlays that apply to the image.
8676
8677 `:margin MARGIN'
8678
8679 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
8680 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
8681 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
8682
8683 `:relief RELIEF'
8684
8685 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
8686 around an image.
8687
8688 `:conversion ALGO'
8689
8690 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
8691
8692 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
8693 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
8694
8695 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
8696 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
8697 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
8698 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
8699 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
8700 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
8701 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
8702 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
8703 below.
8704
8705 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
8706 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
8707 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
8708
8709 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
8710 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
8711 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
8712 of the factors' absolute values.
8713
8714 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
8715
8716 (1 0 0
8717 0 0 0
8718 9 9 -1)
8719
8720 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
8721
8722 ( 2 -1 0
8723 -1 0 1
8724 0 1 -2)
8725
8726 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
8727 ``disabled''.
8728
8729 `:mask MASK'
8730
8731 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
8732 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
8733 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
8734 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
8735 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
8736 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
8737 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
8738 image.
8739
8740 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
8741 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
8742 `:mask nil'.
8743
8744 `:file FILE'
8745
8746 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
8747 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
8748 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
8749 may be present in the image specification.
8750
8751 `:data DATA'
8752
8753 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
8754 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
8755 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
8756 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
8757
8758 *** Supported image types
8759
8760 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
8761
8762 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
8763 properties supported are:
8764
8765 `:foreground FG'
8766
8767 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8768 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8769
8770 `:background BG'
8771
8772 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8773 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8774
8775 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
8776 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
8777 instead of a `:file' property.
8778
8779 `:width WIDTH'
8780
8781 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
8782
8783 `:height HEIGHT'
8784
8785 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
8786
8787 `:data DATA'
8788
8789 DATA must be either
8790
8791 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
8792 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
8793
8794 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
8795
8796 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
8797 bitmap.
8798
8799 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
8800 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
8801 in the file.
8802
8803 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
8804
8805 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
8806 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
8807 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
8808 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
8809
8810 Additional image properties supported are:
8811
8812 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
8813
8814 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
8815 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
8816 name.
8817
8818 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
8819 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
8820
8821 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
8822 to display compressed images.
8823
8824 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
8825
8826 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
8827 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
8828 mono images are:
8829
8830 `:foreground FG'
8831
8832 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
8833 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
8834
8835 `:background FG'
8836
8837 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
8838 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
8839
8840 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
8841
8842 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
8843 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8844 properties defined.
8845
8846 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
8847
8848 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
8849 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8850 properties defined.
8851
8852 **** GIF, image type `gif'
8853
8854 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
8855 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
8856
8857 Additional image properties supported are:
8858
8859 `:index INDEX'
8860
8861 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
8862 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
8863 as a hollow box.
8864
8865 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
8866 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
8867 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
8868 every 0.1 seconds.
8869
8870 (defun show-anim (file max)
8871 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
8872 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
8873
8874 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
8875 (when (= idx max)
8876 (setq idx 0))
8877 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
8878 (save-excursion
8879 (set-buffer buffer)
8880 (goto-char (point-min))
8881 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
8882 (insert-image img "x"))
8883 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
8884
8885 **** PNG, image type `png'
8886
8887 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
8888 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
8889 properties defined.
8890
8891 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
8892
8893 Additional image properties supported are:
8894
8895 `:pt-width WIDTH'
8896
8897 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
8898 integer. This is a required property.
8899
8900 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
8901
8902 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
8903 must be a integer. This is an required property.
8904
8905 `:bounding-box BOX'
8906
8907 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
8908 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
8909 files. This is an required property.
8910
8911 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
8912 lisp/gs.el.
8913
8914 *** Lisp interface.
8915
8916 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
8917 which are supported in the current configuration.
8918
8919 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
8920 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
8921 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
8922 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
8923 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
8924
8925 *** Simplified image API, image.el
8926
8927 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
8928 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
8929 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
8930 define an image based on available image types. The functions
8931 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
8932 buffer.
8933
8934 ** Display margins.
8935
8936 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
8937 and images.
8938
8939 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
8940 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
8941 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
8942 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
8943 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
8944 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
8945 of the display margins.
8946
8947 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
8948 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
8949 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
8950 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
8951 in this file).
8952
8953 ** Help display
8954
8955 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
8956 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
8957 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
8958 that have a `help-echo' property.
8959
8960 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
8961 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
8962 the window in which the help was found.
8963
8964 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
8965 `help-echo' text property was found.
8966
8967 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
8968 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
8969
8970 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
8971 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
8972 mouse.
8973
8974 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
8975 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
8976
8977 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
8978 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
8979 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
8980 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
8981 used as help string.
8982
8983 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
8984 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
8985 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
8986
8987 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
8988
8989 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
8990 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
8991
8992 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
8993 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
8994 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
8995 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
8996 used.
8997
8998 (global-set-key [A-down]
8999 #'(lambda ()
9000 (interactive)
9001 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9002 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
9003 (global-set-key [A-up]
9004 #'(lambda ()
9005 (interactive)
9006 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
9007 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
9008
9009 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
9010
9011 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
9012 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
9013 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
9014 is called with one argument, POS.
9015
9016 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
9017 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
9018 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
9019 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
9020 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
9021
9022 ** Tool bar support.
9023
9024 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
9025 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
9026 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
9027 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
9028 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
9029 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
9030
9031 *** Tool bar item definitions
9032
9033 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
9034 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
9035 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
9036
9037 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
9038 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
9039 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
9040 property (see below).
9041
9042 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
9043 binding are currently ignored.
9044
9045 The following properties are recognized:
9046
9047 `:enable FORM'.
9048
9049 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
9050 or disabled.
9051
9052 `:visible FORM'
9053
9054 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
9055
9056 `:filter FUNCTION'
9057
9058 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
9059 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
9060 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
9061
9062 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
9063
9064 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
9065 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
9066
9067 `:image IMAGES'
9068
9069 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
9070 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
9071 meaning of each of the four elements:
9072
9073 Index Use when item is
9074 ----------------------------------------
9075 0 enabled and selected
9076 1 enabled and deselected
9077 2 disabled and selected
9078 3 disabled and deselected
9079
9080 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
9081 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
9082
9083 `:help HELP-STRING'.
9084
9085 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
9086 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
9087
9088 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
9089 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
9090 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
9091 menu bar.
9092
9093 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
9094 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
9095 buffer-locally to override the global map.
9096
9097 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
9098
9099 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
9100 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
9101 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
9102
9103 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
9104 raised when the mouse moves over them.
9105
9106 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
9107 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
9108 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
9109 vertical margins . Default is 1.
9110
9111 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
9112 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
9113
9114 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
9115
9116 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
9117 a tool bar item. If
9118
9119 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
9120 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
9121 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
9122
9123 is the original tool bar item definition, then
9124
9125 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
9126
9127 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
9128 item.
9129
9130 ** Mode line changes.
9131
9132 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
9133
9134 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
9135 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
9136 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
9137
9138 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
9139 a `local-map' text property.
9140
9141 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
9142 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
9143
9144 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
9145 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
9146 `local-map' property.
9147
9148 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
9149 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
9150 example.
9151
9152 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
9153 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
9154
9155 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
9156 variable mode-line-format to nil.
9157
9158 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
9159
9160 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
9161 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
9162 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
9163 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
9164 line.
9165
9166 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
9167 `header-line'.
9168
9169 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
9170 position in the header-line.
9171
9172 ** Text property `display'
9173
9174 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
9175 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
9176 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
9177 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
9178 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
9179
9180 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
9181
9182 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
9183 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
9184
9185 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
9186 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
9187 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
9188 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9189 simpler form STRING as property value.
9190
9191 *** Variable width and height spaces
9192
9193 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
9194 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
9195 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
9196 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
9197 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
9198 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
9199 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
9200
9201 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
9202 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
9203 properties described below.
9204
9205 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
9206 characters having the `display' property.
9207
9208 - :width WIDTH
9209
9210 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
9211 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
9212
9213 - :relative-width FACTOR
9214
9215 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
9216 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
9217 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
9218 width of that character by FACTOR.
9219
9220 - :align-to HPOS
9221
9222 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
9223 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
9224
9225 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
9226
9227 - :height HEIGHT
9228
9229 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
9230 normal line height.
9231
9232 - :relative-height FACTOR
9233
9234 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
9235 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
9236
9237 - :ascent ASCENT
9238
9239 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
9240 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
9241 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
9242 equal to 100.
9243
9244 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
9245
9246 *** Images
9247
9248 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
9249 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
9250 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
9251 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
9252 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
9253 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
9254 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
9255 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
9256 as display specification.
9257
9258 *** Other display properties
9259
9260 - (space-width FACTOR)
9261
9262 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
9263 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
9264 integer or float.
9265
9266 - (height HEIGHT)
9267
9268 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
9269
9270 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
9271 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
9272 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
9273 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
9274 a font is available counts as a step.
9275
9276 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
9277 as tall as the frame's default font.
9278
9279 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
9280 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
9281
9282 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
9283 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
9284
9285 - (raise FACTOR)
9286
9287 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
9288 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
9289 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
9290 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
9291 `height' subproperty.
9292
9293 *** Conditional display properties
9294
9295 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
9296 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
9297 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
9298 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
9299 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
9300 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
9301 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
9302 different when object is a string.
9303
9304 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
9305 `(when t . SPEC)'.
9306
9307 ** New menu separator types.
9308
9309 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
9310 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
9311 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
9312 to specify other menu separator types.
9313
9314 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
9315
9316 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
9317 separator occurs.
9318
9319 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
9320
9321 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
9322
9323 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
9324
9325 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
9326
9327 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
9328
9329 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9330
9331 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
9332
9333 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
9334
9335 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
9336
9337 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
9338 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
9339
9340 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
9341
9342 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
9343
9344 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
9345
9346 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
9347
9348 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
9349
9350 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
9351
9352 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
9353
9354 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9355
9356 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
9357
9358 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
9359
9360 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
9361
9362 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
9363
9364 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
9365
9366 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
9367
9368 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
9369 the corresponding single-line separators.
9370
9371 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
9372
9373 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
9374 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
9375 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
9376 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
9377 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
9378 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
9379 default foreground is black.
9380
9381 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
9382 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
9383 `ScrollBarBackground').
9384
9385 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
9386 settings for scroll bar colors.
9387
9388 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
9389 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
9390
9391 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
9392 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
9393 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
9394 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
9395 the original window start.
9396
9397 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
9398 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
9399 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
9400
9401 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
9402
9403 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
9404 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
9405 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
9406 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
9407
9408 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
9409 fixed-width and fixed-height.
9410
9411 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
9412
9413 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
9414 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
9415 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
9416 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
9417 temporarily to nil, for example
9418
9419 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
9420 (enlarge-window 10))
9421
9422 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
9423 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
9424
9425 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
9426 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
9427 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
9428 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
9429 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
9430 support a vertical-bar cursor).
9431
9432
9433 \f
9434 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
9435
9436 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
9437 input.
9438
9439 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
9440
9441 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
9442
9443 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
9444 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
9445 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
9446 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
9447 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
9448
9449 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
9450 been added.
9451
9452 \f
9453 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
9454
9455 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
9456
9457
9458 \f
9459 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
9460
9461 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
9462 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
9463 \f
9464 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
9465
9466 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
9467
9468 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
9469 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
9470 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
9471
9472 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
9473 is the one that is used.
9474
9475 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
9476 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
9477 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
9478 separate from the command's regular output.
9479 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
9480 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
9481 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
9482 the buffer name.
9483
9484 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
9485 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
9486 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
9487 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
9488
9489 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
9490 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
9491 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
9492 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
9493
9494 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
9495 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
9496 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
9497 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
9498
9499 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
9500 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
9501 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
9502 they never ignore case.
9503
9504 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
9505 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
9506 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
9507 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
9508 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
9509 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
9510 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
9511
9512 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
9513 the same format that was used in the file before.
9514
9515 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
9516 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
9517
9518 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
9519 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
9520 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
9521
9522 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
9523 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
9524 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
9525 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
9526 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
9527 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
9528 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
9529
9530 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
9531 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
9532 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
9533 format. You can now customize these variables.
9534
9535 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
9536 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
9537 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
9538 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
9539
9540 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
9541 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
9542 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
9543
9544 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
9545 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
9546 doesn't have any effect.
9547
9548 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
9549 not one per buffer.
9550
9551 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
9552 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
9553 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
9554
9555 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
9556 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
9557 `auto-show-mode' command.
9558
9559 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
9560 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
9561 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
9562 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
9563 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
9564
9565 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
9566 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
9567
9568 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
9569 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
9570 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
9571
9572 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
9573 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
9574 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
9575 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
9576
9577 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
9578
9579 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
9580 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
9581 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
9582 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
9583 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
9584
9585 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
9586 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
9587
9588 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
9589 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
9590 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
9591 `?' on other systems.
9592
9593 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
9594 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
9595 Unix.
9596
9597 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
9598 current codepage when it starts.
9599
9600 ** Mail changes
9601
9602 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
9603 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
9604 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
9605 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
9606 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
9607 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
9608 latin-1:
9609
9610 MIME-version: 1.0
9611 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
9612 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
9613
9614 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
9615 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
9616 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
9617 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
9618 buffer-file-coding-system.
9619
9620 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
9621 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
9622 mail.
9623
9624 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
9625 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
9626 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
9627 list of possible coding systems.
9628
9629 ** CC Mode changes
9630
9631 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
9632 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
9633 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
9634 docstring for details.
9635
9636 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
9637 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
9638 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
9639 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
9640 lineup functions use this feature currently.
9641
9642 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
9643 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
9644
9645 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
9646 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
9647
9648 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
9649 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
9650 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
9651 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
9652 anonymous classes.
9653
9654 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
9655 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
9656
9657 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
9658 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
9659 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
9660 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
9661
9662 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
9663 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
9664 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
9665 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
9666 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
9667
9668 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
9669
9670 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
9671
9672 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
9673 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
9674
9675 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
9676
9677 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
9678 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
9679 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
9680 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
9681 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
9682
9683 ** Gnus changes.
9684
9685 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
9686 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
9687 Gnus manual for the full story.
9688
9689 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
9690 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
9691 group, which is created automatically.
9692
9693 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
9694 values.
9695
9696 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
9697
9698 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
9699 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
9700
9701 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
9702 `C-u C-c C-c'.
9703
9704 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
9705
9706 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
9707 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
9708
9709 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
9710
9711 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
9712 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
9713
9714 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
9715 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
9716
9717 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
9718 control over simplification.
9719
9720 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
9721
9722 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
9723 limit.
9724
9725 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
9726
9727 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
9728
9729 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
9730 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
9731 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
9732
9733 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
9734 `a' forces normal posting method.
9735
9736 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
9737 -- `W d'.
9738
9739 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
9740 to a non-nil value.
9741
9742 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
9743 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
9744
9745 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
9746 has been added.
9747
9748 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
9749
9750 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
9751
9752 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
9753 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
9754
9755 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
9756 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
9757
9758 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
9759
9760 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
9761 been added.
9762
9763 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
9764 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
9765
9766 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
9767 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
9768
9769 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
9770
9771 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
9772
9773 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
9774
9775 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
9776
9777 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
9778 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
9779 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
9780
9781 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
9782 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
9783 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
9784 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
9785 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
9786
9787 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
9788 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
9789 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
9790 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
9791
9792 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
9793 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
9794 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
9795 mismatch.
9796
9797 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
9798
9799 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
9800 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
9801
9802 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
9803 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
9804 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
9805 removed from the label.
9806
9807 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
9808 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
9809
9810 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
9811 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
9812
9813 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
9814 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
9815 expressions.
9816
9817 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
9818
9819 ** New/deleted modes and packages
9820
9821 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
9822 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
9823
9824 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
9825 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
9826 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
9827
9828 *** M-x highlight-changes-mode provides a minor mode displaying buffer
9829 changes with a special face.
9830
9831 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
9832 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
9833 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
9834 \f
9835 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
9836
9837 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
9838 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
9839 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
9840 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
9841 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
9842
9843 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
9844 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
9845 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
9846
9847 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
9848 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
9849 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
9850 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
9851 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
9852 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
9853 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
9854 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
9855 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
9856
9857 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
9858 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
9859 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
9860 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
9861 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
9862 program.
9863
9864 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
9865 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
9866 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
9867 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
9868 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
9869 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
9870
9871 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
9872 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
9873 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
9874 was not documented clearly before.
9875
9876 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
9877 This includes Tetris and Snake.
9878 \f
9879 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
9880
9881 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
9882 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
9883 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
9884 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
9885
9886 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
9887 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
9888 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
9889
9890 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
9891
9892 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
9893 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
9894
9895 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
9896 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
9897 integers.
9898
9899 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
9900 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
9901 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
9902 file names and attributes are returned.
9903
9904 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
9905 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
9906 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
9907 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
9908 returns the result.
9909
9910 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
9911 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
9912
9913 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
9914
9915 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
9916 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
9917 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
9918 optionally.
9919
9920 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
9921 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
9922
9923 **
9924 The new function process-running-child-p
9925 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
9926 terminal to its own child process.
9927
9928 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
9929 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
9930 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
9931 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
9932
9933 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
9934 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
9935
9936 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
9937 :included is an alias for :visible.
9938
9939 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
9940 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
9941 to move or copy menu entries.
9942
9943 ** Multibyte editing changes
9944
9945 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
9946 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
9947 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
9948 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
9949 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
9950 (setq char (sref str idx)
9951 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
9952 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
9953
9954 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
9955 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
9956 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
9957
9958 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
9959 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
9960 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
9961
9962 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
9963
9964 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
9965 across the boundary.
9966
9967 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
9968 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
9969 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
9970 contains 8-bit characters.
9971 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
9972 contains invalid characters.
9973
9974 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
9975 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
9976 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
9977 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
9978 way.
9979
9980 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
9981 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
9982 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
9983 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
9984
9985 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
9986 compose Thai characters in a string.
9987
9988 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
9989 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
9990 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
9991 menus should always use the third argument.
9992
9993 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
9994 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
9995 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
9996 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
9997
9998 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
9999 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
10000 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
10001 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
10002
10003 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
10004 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
10005 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
10006 echo area contents.
10007
10008 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
10009
10010 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
10011 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
10012 requested feature cannot be loaded.
10013
10014 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
10015 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
10016 means to clear out that attribute.
10017
10018 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
10019 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
10020
10021 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
10022 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
10023 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
10024 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
10025
10026 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
10027 the gap of the current buffer.
10028
10029 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
10030 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
10031 current buffer.
10032
10033 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
10034 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
10035 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
10036 it back in after any modifications have been made.
10037 \f
10038 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
10039
10040 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
10041 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
10042 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
10043 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
10044 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
10045
10046 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
10047 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
10048 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
10049 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
10050 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
10051
10052 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
10053 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
10054 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
10055
10056 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
10057 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
10058 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
10059 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
10060 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
10061 results.
10062
10063 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
10064 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
10065 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
10066 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
10067 \f
10068 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
10069
10070 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
10071 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
10072 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
10073 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
10074
10075 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
10076 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
10077 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
10078 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
10079 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
10080 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
10081 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
10082 region.
10083
10084 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
10085 selective undo.
10086
10087 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
10088 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
10089 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
10090 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
10091 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
10092
10093 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
10094 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
10095 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
10096 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
10097
10098 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
10099 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
10100 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
10101 something that most users not do.
10102
10103 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
10104 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
10105 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
10106 applications.
10107
10108 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
10109 pasting operations.
10110
10111 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
10112 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
10113 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
10114 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
10115 `ps-printer-name'.
10116
10117 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
10118 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
10119 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
10120 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
10121 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
10122 hits a new word.
10123
10124 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
10125 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
10126 to be confused by TeX commands.
10127
10128 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
10129 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
10130 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
10131 of various alternative replacements and actions.
10132
10133 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
10134 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
10135 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
10136 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
10137 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
10138
10139 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
10140 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
10141
10142 ** Changes in input method usage.
10143
10144 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
10145 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
10146 respectively.
10147
10148 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
10149
10150 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
10151 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
10152
10153 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
10154 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
10155
10156 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
10157
10158 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
10159
10160 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
10161 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
10162
10163 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
10164 given in the following case:
10165 o When you are using a complex input method.
10166 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
10167
10168 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
10169 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
10170 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
10171 setting it to t is helpful.
10172
10173 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
10174
10175 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
10176 keys:
10177 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
10178 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
10179 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
10180 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
10181 environment.
10182
10183 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
10184 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
10185 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
10186 get
10187
10188 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
10189
10190 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
10191
10192 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
10193 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
10194
10195 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
10196 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
10197 its owner and group.
10198
10199 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
10200 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
10201
10202 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
10203 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
10204
10205 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
10206 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
10207 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
10208 by the left edge of the rectangle.
10209
10210 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
10211 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
10212 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
10213 for writing keyboard macros.
10214
10215 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
10216 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
10217 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
10218 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
10219 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
10220 info.
10221
10222 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
10223
10224 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
10225 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
10226 contents only.
10227
10228 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
10229 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
10230 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
10231 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
10232
10233 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
10234 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
10235 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
10236
10237 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
10238 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
10239 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
10240 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
10241
10242 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
10243 failure if the command produces no output.
10244
10245 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
10246 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
10247 the mouse.
10248
10249 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
10250 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
10251 function and variable names.
10252
10253 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
10254 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
10255 file-coding-system-alist.
10256
10257 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
10258 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
10259 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
10260 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
10261 according to the current fontset.
10262
10263 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
10264
10265 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
10266 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
10267 nonascii-insert-offset.
10268
10269 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
10270 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
10271 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
10272 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
10273
10274 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
10275 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
10276
10277 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
10278 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
10279
10280 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
10281 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
10282 command keys.
10283
10284 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
10285 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
10286
10287 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
10288 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
10289 all variables that have documentation.
10290
10291 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
10292 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
10293 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
10294 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
10295 it should show; the default is 20.
10296
10297 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
10298 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
10299 of your input.
10300
10301 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
10302 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
10303 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
10304 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
10305 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
10306 Newly added options are included as well.
10307
10308 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
10309 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
10310 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
10311
10312 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
10313 Customize menu.
10314
10315 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
10316 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
10317
10318 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
10319 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
10320 invoked.
10321
10322 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
10323 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
10324 The default is 1.
10325
10326 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
10327 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
10328 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
10329 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
10330 sensibly.
10331
10332 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
10333
10334 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
10335 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
10336 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
10337
10338 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
10339 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
10340 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
10341 every night.
10342
10343 ** Desktop changes
10344
10345 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
10346 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
10347
10348 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
10349 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
10350
10351 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
10352 read and post multi-lingual articles.
10353
10354 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
10355 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
10356 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
10357 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
10358 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
10359 made invisible again.
10360
10361 ** Mail reading and sending changes
10362
10363 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
10364 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
10365 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
10366 toggle.
10367
10368 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
10369 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
10370 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
10371 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
10372 rmail-default-body-file.
10373
10374 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
10375 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
10376 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
10377
10378 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
10379 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
10380 is evaluated to insert the signature.
10381
10382 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
10383 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
10384 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
10385 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
10386 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
10387 especially interested in trying feedmail.
10388
10389 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
10390 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
10391 provided by feedmail are:
10392
10393 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
10394 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
10395 there is also a queue for draft messages
10396
10397 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
10398 be prompted for confirmation
10399
10400 **** does smart filling of address headers
10401
10402 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
10403 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
10404 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
10405
10406 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
10407 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
10408 /usr/lib/sendmail, and elisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
10409 function for something else (10-20 lines of elisp)
10410
10411 ** Dired changes
10412
10413 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
10414 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
10415
10416 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
10417 run Dired on the directory name at point.
10418
10419 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
10420 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
10421 for a specified regexp.
10422
10423 ** VC Changes
10424
10425 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
10426 conveniently.
10427
10428 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
10429 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
10430 Dired.
10431
10432 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
10433 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
10434 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
10435 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
10436
10437 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
10438 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
10439 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
10440 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
10441 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
10442
10443 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
10444 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
10445 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
10446 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
10447 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
10448
10449 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
10450 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
10451 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
10452 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
10453
10454 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
10455 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
10456 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
10457
10458 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
10459 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
10460 session to resolve them.
10461
10462 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
10463 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
10464 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
10465 uses as well).
10466
10467 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
10468 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
10469 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
10470 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
10471 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
10472 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
10473 using ediff.
10474
10475 ** Changes in Font Lock
10476
10477 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
10478 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
10479 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
10480 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
10481 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
10482
10483 ** Frame name display changes
10484
10485 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
10486 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
10487 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
10488 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
10489
10490 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
10491 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
10492 menu.
10493
10494 ** Comint (subshell) changes
10495
10496 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
10497 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
10498 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
10499
10500 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
10501
10502 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
10503 that is, the line after the last line you got.
10504 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
10505
10506 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
10507 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
10508 the following line.
10509
10510 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
10511 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
10512 previously sent input.
10513
10514 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
10515 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
10516 as the search string.
10517
10518 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
10519 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
10520
10521 ** C mode changes
10522
10523 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
10524 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
10525 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
10526 definition.
10527
10528 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
10529 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
10530 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
10531 style is still the default however.
10532
10533 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
10534
10535 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
10536 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
10537 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
10538
10539 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
10540 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
10541
10542 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
10543 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
10544
10545 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
10546 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
10547
10548 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
10549 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
10550
10551 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
10552 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
10553 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
10554 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
10555
10556 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
10557
10558 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
10559 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
10560 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
10561
10562 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
10563 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
10564 expanding dynamically.
10565
10566 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
10567 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
10568
10569 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
10570 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
10571 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
10572 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
10573
10574 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
10575
10576 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
10577
10578 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
10579 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
10580 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
10581 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
10582 against the first word in the title.
10583
10584 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
10585 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
10586 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
10587 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
10588 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
10589 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
10590
10591 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
10592 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
10593 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
10594 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
10595
10596 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
10597
10598 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
10599 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
10600 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
10601 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
10602 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
10603 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
10604
10605 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
10606 Editing group once the package is loaded.
10607
10608 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
10609 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
10610 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
10611
10612 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
10613 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
10614
10615 ** Ispell changes.
10616
10617 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
10618 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
10619 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
10620
10621 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
10622 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
10623 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
10624 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
10625 include:
10626
10627 o URLs are automatically skipped
10628 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
10629
10630 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
10631
10632 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10633
10634 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
10635 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
10636 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
10637 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
10638
10639 *** New recursive parser.
10640
10641 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
10642 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
10643 recursive parser scans the individual files.
10644
10645 *** Parsing only part of a document.
10646
10647 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
10648 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
10649 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
10650
10651 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
10652
10653 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
10654
10655 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
10656
10657 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
10658
10659 *** Using multiple selection buffers
10660
10661 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
10662 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
10663
10664 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
10665
10666 *** References to external documents.
10667
10668 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
10669 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
10670 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
10671 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
10672 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
10673 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
10674 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
10675
10676 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
10677
10678 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
10679 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
10680
10681 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
10682 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
10683
10684 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
10685
10686 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
10687 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
10688
10689 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
10690
10691 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
10692 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
10693 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
10694 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
10695 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
10696 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
10697 more.
10698
10699 *** Support for the varioref package
10700
10701 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
10702
10703 *** New hooks
10704
10705 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
10706 and citations are created. These hooks are
10707 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
10708 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
10709
10710 *** Citations outside LaTeX
10711
10712 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
10713 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
10714
10715 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
10716
10717 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
10718 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
10719 fontified, use
10720
10721 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
10722
10723 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
10724 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
10725 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
10726 directories that contain the same file name.
10727
10728 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
10729 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
10730 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
10731 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
10732 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
10733 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
10734 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
10735 directory.
10736
10737 ** New modes and packages
10738
10739 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
10740 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
10741 it, but some do not.
10742
10743 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
10744 code.
10745
10746 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
10747 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
10748 around in a buffer.
10749
10750 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
10751
10752 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
10753 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
10754 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
10755 established system of notation similar to Chess.
10756
10757 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
10758 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
10759 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
10760
10761 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
10762 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
10763 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc); others are implementations of
10764 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
10765 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
10766 the like.
10767
10768 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
10769 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
10770
10771 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
10772 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
10773 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
10774 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
10775
10776 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
10777
10778 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
10779 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
10780 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
10781 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
10782 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc)
10783 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
10784 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
10785 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
10786 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
10787 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
10788 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
10789
10790 Platform-specific modes:
10791
10792 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
10793 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
10794 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
10795 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
10796 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
10797 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
10798 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
10799 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
10800 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
10801 \f
10802 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10803
10804 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
10805 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
10806 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
10807 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
10808
10809 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
10810 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
10811 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
10812
10813 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
10814 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
10815 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
10816 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
10817
10818 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
10819 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
10820 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
10821 environment.
10822
10823 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
10824 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
10825 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
10826 current input method for reading this one event.
10827
10828 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
10829 now control whether to output certain characters as
10830 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
10831 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
10832 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
10833 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
10834 \f
10835 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
10836
10837 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
10838 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
10839
10840 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
10841 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
10842 always increases point by 1.
10843
10844 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
10845 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
10846
10847 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
10848
10849 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
10850 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
10851 default value changed. For example,
10852
10853 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
10854 :type 'integer
10855 :group 'foo
10856 :version "20.3")
10857
10858 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
10859 :version "20.3")
10860
10861 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
10862 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
10863 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
10864 `:version' in the top level group.
10865
10866 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
10867
10868 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
10869 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
10870
10871 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
10872 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
10873 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
10874 to themselves.
10875
10876 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
10877 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
10878 values whatever.
10879
10880 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
10881 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
10882 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
10883
10884 ** Frame-local variables.
10885
10886 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
10887 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
10888 local bindings for that variable.
10889
10890 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
10891 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
10892 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
10893 parameter name.
10894
10895 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
10896 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
10897 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
10898 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
10899
10900 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
10901 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
10902 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
10903 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
10904
10905 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
10906 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
10907 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
10908 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
10909 See the documentation in sregex.el.
10910
10911 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
10912 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
10913 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
10914 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
10915
10916 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
10917 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
10918
10919 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
10920 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
10921 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
10922
10923 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
10924 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
10925 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
10926 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
10927
10928 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
10929 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
10930 empty input.
10931
10932 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
10933 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
10934 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
10935 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
10936 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
10937
10938 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
10939 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
10940 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
10941 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
10942
10943 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
10944 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
10945 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
10946 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
10947 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
10948
10949 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
10950 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
10951 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
10952 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
10953
10954 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
10955 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
10956 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
10957
10958 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
10959 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
10960 was directed to display this buffer.
10961
10962 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
10963 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
10964 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
10965 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
10966 set-window-configuration.
10967
10968 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
10969 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
10970 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
10971 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
10972
10973 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
10974 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
10975 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
10976
10977 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
10978 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
10979 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
10980
10981 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
10982 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
10983
10984 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
10985 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
10986
10987 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
10988 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
10989 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
10990
10991 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
10992 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
10993 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
10994 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
10995
10996 ** Menu changes
10997
10998 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
10999 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
11000 better supported.
11001
11002 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
11003 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
11004 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
11005 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
11006 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
11007
11008 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
11009
11010 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
11011 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
11012 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
11013 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
11014
11015 The format is:
11016 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
11017 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
11018 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
11019 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
11020 The supported properties include
11021
11022 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11023 item is enabled.
11024 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
11025 item should appear in the menu.
11026 :filter FILTER-FN
11027 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
11028 which will be REAL-BINDING.
11029 It should return a binding to use instead.
11030 :keys DESCRIPTION
11031 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
11032 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
11033 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
11034 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
11035 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
11036 keyboard binding.
11037 :key-sequence nil
11038 This means that the command normally has no
11039 keyboard equivalent.
11040 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
11041 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
11042 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
11043 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
11044 value says whether this button is currently selected.
11045
11046 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
11047 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
11048
11049 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
11050
11051 ** New event types
11052
11053 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
11054 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
11055 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
11056 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
11057
11058 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
11059
11060 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11061 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
11062 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
11063 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
11064 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
11065 forward, away from the user.
11066
11067 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11068
11069 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
11070 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
11071 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
11072 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
11073 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
11074
11075 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
11076
11077 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
11078 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
11079 that were dragged and dropped.
11080
11081 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
11082
11083 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
11084
11085 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
11086 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
11087 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
11088
11089 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
11090 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
11091 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
11092
11093 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
11094 in Emacs 19 and before.
11095
11096 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
11097 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
11098
11099 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
11100 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
11101 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
11102 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
11103
11104 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
11105 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
11106 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
11107 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
11108 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
11109
11110 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
11111 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
11112 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
11113 consistent with the new representation.
11114
11115 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
11116 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
11117 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
11118 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11119
11120 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
11121 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
11122 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
11123
11124 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
11125 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
11126 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
11127
11128 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
11129 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
11130 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
11131
11132 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11133 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
11134
11135 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
11136 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
11137
11138 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
11139 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
11140 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
11141 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
11142
11143 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
11144 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
11145
11146 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
11147 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
11148 buffer or string being searched.
11149
11150 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
11151 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
11152 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
11153 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
11154 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
11155 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
11156 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
11157
11158 *** Structure of coding system changed.
11159
11160 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
11161 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
11162 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
11163 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
11164 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
11165 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
11166 define-coding-system-alias.
11167
11168 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
11169 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
11170 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
11171 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
11172 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
11173 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
11174 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
11175 `iso-8859-1'.
11176
11177 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
11178 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
11179 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
11180 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
11181
11182 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
11183 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
11184 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
11185 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
11186
11187 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
11188 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
11189 This function requires a user interaction.
11190
11191 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
11192 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
11193 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
11194 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
11195 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
11196 select-safe-coding-system.
11197
11198 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
11199 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
11200 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
11201 was done.
11202
11203 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
11204 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
11205 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
11206
11207 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
11208 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
11209 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
11210 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
11211
11212 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
11213 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
11214 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
11215 converted.
11216
11217 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
11218 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
11219
11220 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
11221 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
11222 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
11223 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
11224 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
11225 range of characters.
11226
11227 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
11228 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
11229
11230 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
11231 in the current buffer at position POS.
11232
11233 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
11234 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
11235 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
11236 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
11237 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
11238 binding input-method-function to nil.
11239
11240 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
11241 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
11242 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
11243 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
11244 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
11245
11246 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
11247 subsequent events of a key sequence.
11248
11249 *** You can customize any language environment by using
11250 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
11251
11252 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
11253 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
11254 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
11255 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
11256 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
11257 \f
11258 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
11259
11260 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
11261 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
11262 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
11263 tree structure.
11264
11265 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
11266 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
11267
11268 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
11269 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
11270 in your .emacs file.)
11271
11272 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
11273 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
11274
11275 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
11276 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
11277
11278 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
11279 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
11280 kills the region.
11281
11282 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
11283 delete the character before point, as usual.
11284
11285 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
11286 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
11287 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
11288
11289 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
11290 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
11291 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
11292 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
11293 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
11294 past.)
11295
11296 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
11297 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
11298 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
11299 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
11300 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
11301
11302 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
11303 and is an alias for it.
11304
11305 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
11306 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
11307
11308 ** Scrolling changes
11309
11310 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
11311 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
11312
11313 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
11314 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
11315 where it started.
11316
11317 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
11318 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
11319 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
11320 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
11321
11322 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
11323 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
11324 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
11325 recenters the window.
11326
11327 ** International character set support (MULE)
11328
11329 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
11330 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
11331 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
11332 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
11333 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
11334 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
11335
11336 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
11337 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
11338 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
11339 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
11340 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
11341
11342 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
11343 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
11344 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
11345 language, to make it possible to type them.
11346
11347 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
11348 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
11349
11350 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
11351 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
11352
11353 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
11354
11355 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
11356
11357 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
11358 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
11359 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
11360 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
11361 characters for their work until they want to change.
11362
11363 *** Input methods
11364
11365 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
11366 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
11367 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
11368 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
11369 support several input methods.
11370
11371 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
11372 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
11373 work.
11374
11375 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
11376 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
11377 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
11378 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
11379 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
11380 letter.
11381
11382 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
11383 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
11384 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
11385 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
11386 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
11387
11388 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
11389 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
11390 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
11391 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
11392
11393 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
11394 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
11395 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
11396 the first guess is wrong.
11397
11398 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
11399 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
11400
11401 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
11402 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
11403 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
11404 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
11405
11406 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
11407 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
11408 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
11409 translate automatically to and from either one.
11410
11411 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
11412
11413 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
11414 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
11415 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
11416 what you want.
11417
11418 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
11419 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
11420 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
11421 multibyte characters in that buffer.
11422
11423 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
11424 character conversion as well.
11425
11426 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
11427
11428 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
11429 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
11430 requires using many fonts.
11431
11432 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
11433 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
11434
11435 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
11436 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
11437 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
11438 you would use a font.
11439
11440 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
11441 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
11442 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
11443
11444 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
11445 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
11446 characters).
11447
11448 *** Defining fontsets.
11449
11450 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
11451 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
11452 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
11453
11454 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
11455 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
11456 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
11457 standard fontset are created automatically.
11458
11459 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
11460 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
11461 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
11462 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
11463 name is `fontset-startup'.
11464
11465 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
11466 The resource value should have this form:
11467 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
11468 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
11469 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
11470 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
11471 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
11472 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
11473 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
11474 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
11475 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
11476
11477 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
11478 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
11479 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
11480
11481 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
11482 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
11483 following resource,
11484 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
11485 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
11486 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
11487 Here is the substitution rule:
11488 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
11489 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
11490 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
11491 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
11492 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
11493
11494 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
11495 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
11496 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
11497
11498 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
11499 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
11500 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
11501 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
11502 fontsets.
11503
11504 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
11505 defaults for a particular choice of language.
11506
11507 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
11508 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
11509 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
11510 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
11511 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
11512 system for new files that you create.
11513
11514 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
11515 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
11516 whole Emacs session.
11517
11518 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
11519 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
11520 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
11521
11522 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
11523 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
11524 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
11525 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
11526 coding systems that Emacs supports.
11527
11528 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
11529 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
11530 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
11531 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
11532 is used for *the immediately following command*.
11533
11534 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
11535 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
11536
11537 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
11538 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
11539
11540 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
11541 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
11542
11543 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
11544 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
11545 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
11546 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
11547 of the file.
11548
11549 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
11550 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
11551 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
11552 translated into that character code.
11553
11554 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
11555 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
11556
11557 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
11558
11559 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
11560 the coding system for keyboard input.
11561
11562 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
11563 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
11564 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
11565
11566 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
11567
11568 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
11569 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
11570 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
11571 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
11572 designed to work with terminals.
11573
11574 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
11575 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
11576 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
11577 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
11578 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
11579 in the corresponding buffer.
11580
11581 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
11582
11583 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
11584 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
11585 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
11586
11587 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
11588 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
11589 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
11590 want to use.
11591
11592 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
11593 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
11594
11595 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
11596 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
11597 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
11598 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
11599
11600 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
11601 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
11602 related information.
11603
11604 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
11605 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
11606 scripts.
11607
11608 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
11609 information about the support for a particular language.
11610 You specify the language as an argument.
11611
11612 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
11613 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
11614 first dash.
11615
11616 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
11617 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
11618 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
11619 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
11620
11621 A alternativnyj (Russian)
11622 B big5 (Chinese)
11623 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
11624 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
11625 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
11626 E euc-japan (Japanese)
11627 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11628 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
11629 K euc-korea (Korean)
11630 R koi8 (Russian)
11631 Q tibetan
11632 S shift_jis (Japanese)
11633 T lao
11634 T tis620 (Thai)
11635 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
11636 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
11637 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
11638 v viqr (Vietnamese)
11639 z hz (Chinese)
11640
11641 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
11642 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
11643 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
11644 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
11645
11646 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
11647 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
11648
11649 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
11650 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
11651 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
11652 Rmail files themselves.
11653
11654 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
11655 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
11656
11657 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
11658 for sending mail:
11659
11660 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
11661 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
11662 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
11663 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
11664 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
11665
11666 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
11667 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
11668 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
11669 translations.
11670
11671 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
11672 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
11673 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
11674 without any conversion.
11675
11676 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
11677 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
11678 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
11679 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
11680
11681 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
11682 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
11683
11684 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
11685 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
11686
11687 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
11688 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
11689
11690 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
11691 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
11692 in the buffer before point.
11693
11694 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
11695 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
11696 you are using.
11697
11698 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
11699 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
11700
11701 ** File locking works with NFS now.
11702
11703 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
11704 in the same directory as FILENAME.
11705
11706 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
11707 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
11708 can become a bottleneck.
11709
11710 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
11711 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
11712 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
11713 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
11714 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
11715 so useful that the change is worth while.
11716
11717 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
11718 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
11719 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
11720 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
11721
11722 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
11723 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
11724 show-paren-mode.
11725
11726 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
11727 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
11728 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
11729
11730 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
11731 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
11732 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
11733
11734 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
11735 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
11736 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
11737
11738 ** Changes in View mode.
11739
11740 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
11741 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
11742
11743 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
11744 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
11745
11746 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
11747 previous state.
11748
11749 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
11750 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
11751
11752 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
11753 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
11754 not just the selected window.
11755
11756 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
11757 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
11758 turns View mode on or off.
11759
11760 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
11761 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
11762 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
11763
11764 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
11765 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
11766
11767 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
11768 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
11769 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
11770 which version to compare with.
11771
11772 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
11773 blocks if a match is inside the block.
11774
11775 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
11776 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
11777 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
11778 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
11779
11780 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
11781 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
11782 blocks, all of them or none.
11783
11784 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
11785 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
11786 confirmation first.
11787
11788 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
11789 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
11790 However, the mode will not be changed if
11791 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
11792 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
11793 not suitable for ordinary files, or
11794 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
11795
11796 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
11797
11798 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
11799 these commands do not change the major mode.
11800
11801 ** M-x occur changes.
11802
11803 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
11804 it performs a case-sensitive search.
11805
11806 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
11807 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
11808 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
11809
11810 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
11811 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
11812 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
11813 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
11814 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
11815
11816 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
11817 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
11818 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
11819 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
11820
11821 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
11822 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
11823 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
11824
11825 ** Outline mode changes.
11826
11827 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
11828
11829 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
11830
11831 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
11832 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
11833 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
11834 was already active.
11835
11836 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
11837 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
11838 get confused by it.
11839
11840 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
11841 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
11842
11843 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
11844
11845 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
11846 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
11847 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
11848 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
11849
11850 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
11851 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
11852 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
11853
11854 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
11855 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
11856 values.
11857
11858 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
11859 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
11860 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
11861 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
11862
11863 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
11864 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
11865 can be. The default value is 30.
11866
11867 ** Changes in Mail mode.
11868
11869 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
11870 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
11871 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
11872 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
11873 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
11874 behavior.
11875
11876 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
11877 compose-mail-other-frame.
11878
11879 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
11880 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
11881 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
11882 buffer that shows the original message.
11883
11884 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
11885 with separator lines around the contents.
11886
11887 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
11888 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
11889 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
11890 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
11891
11892 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
11893
11894 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
11895 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
11896 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
11897 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
11898
11899 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
11900 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
11901 /etc/passwd.
11902
11903 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
11904 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
11905 /etc/passwd.
11906
11907 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
11908 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
11909 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
11910 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
11911
11912 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
11913 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
11914 be taken to be magic.
11915
11916 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
11917 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
11918 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
11919
11920 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
11921 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
11922
11923 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
11924 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
11925
11926 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
11927
11928 new key dired.el binding old key
11929 ------- ---------------- -------
11930 * c dired-change-marks c
11931 * m dired-mark m
11932 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
11933 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
11934 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
11935 * u dired-unmark u
11936 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
11937 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
11938 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
11939 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
11940 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
11941 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
11942
11943 ** Rmail changes.
11944
11945 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
11946 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
11947 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
11948 each time you run it.
11949
11950 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
11951 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
11952
11953 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
11954 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
11955 means to move in the opposite direction.
11956
11957 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
11958 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
11959
11960 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
11961 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
11962 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
11963 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
11964 for output.
11965
11966 ** Gnus changes.
11967
11968 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
11969
11970 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
11971 Gnus.
11972
11973 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
11974 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
11975
11976 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
11977 article mode line.
11978
11979 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
11980
11981 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
11982
11983 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
11984
11985 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
11986 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
11987 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
11988
11989 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
11990
11991 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
11992
11993 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
11994 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
11995
11996 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
11997 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
11998 used to pick articles.
11999
12000 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
12001 another have been added.
12002
12003 `M-x gnus-change-server'
12004
12005 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
12006 generating lines in buffers.
12007
12008 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
12009 `C-M-_'.
12010
12011 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
12012
12013 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
12014
12015 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
12016
12017 *** Scores can be decayed.
12018
12019 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
12020
12021 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
12022 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
12023
12024 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
12025 the native server.
12026
12027 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
12028
12029 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
12030 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
12031
12032 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
12033
12034 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
12035 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
12036
12037 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
12038 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
12039
12040 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
12041 a group.
12042
12043 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
12044 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
12045
12046 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
12047
12048 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
12049
12050 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
12051
12052 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
12053
12054 Use the `Y c' command.
12055
12056 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
12057
12058 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
12059
12060 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
12061
12062 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
12063 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
12064
12065 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
12066
12067 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
12068
12069 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
12070 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
12071
12072 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
12073
12074 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
12075 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
12076 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
12077 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
12078 this issue.)
12079
12080 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
12081 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
12082 particular news group. This can be done by:
12083
12084 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
12085
12086 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
12087 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
12088 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
12089 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
12090 for reading and posting).
12091
12092 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
12093 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
12094 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
12095 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
12096 there.
12097
12098 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
12099 default. Here are some of these default settings:
12100
12101 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
12102 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
12103 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
12104 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
12105 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
12106
12107 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
12108 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
12109
12110 ** CC mode changes.
12111
12112 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
12113 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
12114 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
12115 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
12116 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
12117 loaded.
12118
12119 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
12120 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
12121 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
12122 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
12123 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
12124 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
12125
12126 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
12127 of the current buffer.
12128
12129 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
12130 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
12131 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
12132
12133 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
12134 style that the Python developers like.
12135
12136 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
12137 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
12138 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
12139
12140 ** VC Changes [new]
12141
12142 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
12143 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
12144 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
12145
12146 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
12147 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
12148 developers.
12149
12150 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
12151 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
12152
12153 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
12154 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
12155 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
12156 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
12157
12158 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
12159 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
12160
12161 ** Calendar changes.
12162
12163 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
12164 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
12165 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
12166 following/previous years.
12167
12168 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
12169 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
12170 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
12171 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
12172 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
12173 supposed attribute of God.
12174
12175 ** ps-print changes
12176
12177 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
12178 layout.
12179
12180 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
12181
12182 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
12183 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
12184 printer system has this behavior, set variable
12185 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
12186
12187 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
12188 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
12189 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
12190
12191 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
12192 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
12193
12194 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
12195 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
12196 printing for your printer.
12197
12198 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
12199 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12200
12201 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
12202 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
12203
12204 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
12205 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
12206 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
12207 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
12208 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
12209 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
12210 The default value is nil.
12211
12212 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
12213 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
12214
12215 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
12216 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
12217 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
12218 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
12219 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
12220 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
12221 color). The default is 0 ("black").
12222
12223 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
12224 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
12225
12226 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
12227 The default is 0 ("black").
12228
12229 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
12230 The default is 0 ("black").
12231
12232 border-width Specify the border width.
12233 The default is 0.4.
12234
12235 Any other property is ignored.
12236
12237 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
12238 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
12239 documentation).
12240
12241 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
12242 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
12243 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
12244 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
12245 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
12246 controlling headers.
12247
12248 *** Color management (subgroup)
12249
12250 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
12251 color.
12252
12253 *** Face Management (subgroup)
12254
12255 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
12256 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
12257 background should be used. Valid values are:
12258
12259 t always use face background color.
12260 nil never use face background color.
12261 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
12262
12263 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
12264
12265 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
12266 sheet of paper.
12267
12268 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
12269 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
12270
12271 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
12272 each page.
12273
12274 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
12275 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
12276 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
12277
12278 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
12279 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
12280 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
12281
12282 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
12283 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
12284 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
12285
12286 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
12287 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
12288 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
12289
12290 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
12291 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
12292 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
12293
12294 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
12295
12296 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
12297
12298 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
12299 RGB color.
12300
12301 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
12302 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
12303 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
12304
12305 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
12306 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12307 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12308 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12309 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12310 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
12311 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
12312 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
12313 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12314 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12315 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12316 10 + 10 +
12317 11 + 11 +
12318 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12319 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12320 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
12321 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
12322 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
12323 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12324 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12325 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
12326 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
12327 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
12328 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
12329 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
12330 22 + 22 +
12331 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
12332
12333 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
12334
12335
12336 *** Printer management (subgroup)
12337
12338 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
12339 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
12340 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
12341 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
12342 to "-P".
12343
12344 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
12345 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
12346 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
12347
12348 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
12349 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
12350 do so.
12351
12352 *** Page settings (subgroup)
12353
12354 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
12355 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
12356 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
12357 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
12358 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
12359 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
12360 `setpagedevice'.
12361
12362 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
12363 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
12364 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
12365
12366 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
12367 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
12368 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
12369 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
12370 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
12371 its TO, are ignored.
12372
12373 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
12374 pages. Valid values are:
12375
12376 nil print all pages.
12377
12378 `even-page' print only even pages.
12379
12380 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
12381
12382 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
12383 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12384 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
12385 print only the even sheet of paper.
12386
12387 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
12388 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
12389 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
12390 only the odd sheet of paper.
12391
12392 Any other value is treated as nil.
12393
12394 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
12395 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
12396 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
12397
12398 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
12399
12400 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
12401 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
12402
12403 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
12404 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12405 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
12406 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12407 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12408 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
12409 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
12410
12411 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
12412 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
12413 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
12414 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
12415 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
12416 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
12417 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
12418
12419 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
12420
12421 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
12422 messages should be sent.
12423
12424 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
12425 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
12426 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
12427
12428 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
12429
12430 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
12431 points for line numbers.
12432
12433 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
12434 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
12435
12436 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
12437 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
12438 to 2, the printing will look like:
12439
12440 1 one line
12441 one line
12442 3 one line
12443 one line
12444 5 one line
12445 one line
12446 ...
12447
12448 Valid values are:
12449
12450 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
12451 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
12452 is used.
12453
12454 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
12455 zebra stripe is to be printed.
12456
12457 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
12458
12459 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
12460 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
12461 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
12462 3, the output will look like:
12463
12464 one line
12465 one line
12466 3 one line
12467 one line
12468 one line
12469 6 one line
12470 one line
12471 one line
12472 9 one line
12473 one line
12474 ...
12475
12476 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
12477 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
12478
12479 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
12480 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12481 `ps-font-size').
12482
12483 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
12484 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
12485 `ps-font-size').
12486
12487 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
12488
12489 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
12490 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
12491
12492 ** hideshow changes.
12493
12494 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
12495 C++, ; for lisp).
12496
12497 *** Support for java-mode added.
12498
12499 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
12500 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
12501
12502 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
12503 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
12504 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
12505
12506 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
12507 robust and a lot faster.
12508
12509 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
12510
12511 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
12512 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
12513 documentation for more details.
12514
12515 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
12516
12517 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
12518 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
12519 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
12520 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
12521 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
12522
12523 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
12524 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
12525 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
12526 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
12527
12528 ** Font Lock mode
12529
12530 *** Custom support
12531
12532 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
12533 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify the
12534 faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new custom
12535 group font-lock-highlighting-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in
12536 your ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
12537 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
12538
12539 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
12540
12541 *** Maximum decoration
12542
12543 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
12544 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
12545 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
12546 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
12547 to get the old behavior.
12548
12549 *** New support
12550
12551 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
12552
12553 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
12554 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
12555
12556 *** Configurable support
12557
12558 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
12559 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
12560 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
12561 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
12562 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
12563 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
12564 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
12565
12566 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
12567 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
12568 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
12569
12570 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
12571
12572 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
12573 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
12574 for any mode.
12575
12576 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
12577
12578 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
12579
12580 in your ~/.emacs.
12581
12582 *** New faces
12583
12584 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
12585 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
12586 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
12587 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
12588
12589 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
12590
12591 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
12592 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
12593 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
12594
12595 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
12596
12597 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
12598 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
12599 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
12600 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
12601 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
12602 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
12603 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
12604
12605 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
12606 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
12607 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
12608 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
12609 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
12610 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
12611
12612 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
12613
12614 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
12615 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
12616 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
12617 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
12618
12619 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
12620 settings.
12621
12622 ** Ada mode changes.
12623
12624 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
12625 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
12626 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
12627 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
12628 stubs.
12629
12630 *** There are two new commands:
12631 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
12632 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
12633
12634 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
12635 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
12636 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
12637
12638 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
12639 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
12640 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
12641
12642 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
12643 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
12644 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
12645 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
12646
12647 ** Scheme mode changes.
12648
12649 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
12650 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
12651 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
12652 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
12653 have any effect.
12654
12655 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
12656 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
12657 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
12658 variables as buffer-local variables.
12659
12660 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
12661 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
12662
12663 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
12664
12665 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
12666 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
12667 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
12668 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
12669
12670 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
12671 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
12672 buffer in Emacs.
12673
12674 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
12675 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
12676 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
12677 option takes precedence.
12678
12679 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
12680 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
12681 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
12682
12683 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
12684 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
12685 the current defun.
12686
12687 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
12688 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
12689
12690 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
12691 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
12692 necessary).
12693
12694 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
12695 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
12696 these register values no longer become completely useless.
12697 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
12698 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
12699 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
12700
12701 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
12702 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
12703 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
12704 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
12705
12706 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
12707 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
12708 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
12709 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
12710 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
12711
12712 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
12713 since it applies only to the current frame.
12714
12715 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
12716 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
12717 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
12718
12719 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
12720 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
12721 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
12722 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
12723 instead of just the file you are editing.
12724
12725 ** RefTeX mode
12726
12727 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
12728 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
12729 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
12730 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
12731 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
12732
12733 C-c ( reftex-label
12734 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
12735 knows which kind of label is needed.
12736
12737 C-c ) reftex-reference
12738 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
12739 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
12740
12741 C-c [ reftex-citation
12742 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
12743 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
12744
12745 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
12746 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
12747
12748 C-c = reftex-toc
12749 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
12750 can quickly jump to every section.
12751
12752 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
12753 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
12754 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
12755 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
12756 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
12757
12758 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
12759
12760 *** Info documentation is now available.
12761
12762 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
12763 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
12764
12765 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
12766 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
12767
12768 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
12769 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
12770
12771 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
12772 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
12773 appropriate functions.
12774
12775 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
12776 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
12777
12778 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
12779 been cleaned.
12780
12781 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
12782 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
12783
12784 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
12785 shall be delimited.
12786
12787 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
12788 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
12789 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
12790
12791 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
12792 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
12793 prefixed with `ALT'.
12794
12795 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
12796 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
12797 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
12798 documentation).
12799
12800 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
12801 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
12802 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
12803
12804 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
12805 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
12806
12807 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
12808 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
12809 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
12810
12811 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
12812
12813 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
12814
12815 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
12816 from alien sources.
12817
12818 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
12819 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
12820 crossref entries.
12821
12822 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
12823 region.
12824
12825 *** Added support for imenu.
12826
12827 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
12828 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
12829 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
12830 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
12831
12832 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
12833 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
12834
12835 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
12836
12837 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
12838
12839 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
12840 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
12841 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
12842 as an argument.
12843
12844 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
12845 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
12846
12847 ** browse-url changes
12848
12849 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
12850 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
12851 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
12852 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
12853 customization variables.
12854
12855 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
12856
12857 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
12858 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
12859 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
12860
12861 ** Changes in Ediff
12862
12863 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
12864 pops up the Info file for this command.
12865
12866 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
12867 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
12868 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
12869 directories).
12870
12871 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
12872 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
12873 files in the same directory.
12874
12875 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
12876 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
12877 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
12878
12879 ** Changes in Viper
12880
12881 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
12882 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
12883 instead of vip-.
12884 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
12885 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
12886 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
12887 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
12888 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
12889 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
12890 color when Viper is in insert state.
12891 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
12892 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
12893 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
12894
12895 ** Etags changes.
12896
12897 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
12898 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
12899 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
12900 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
12901 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
12902
12903 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
12904
12905 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
12906 constructs are tagged. Files are recognised by the extension .java.
12907
12908 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
12909 recognised by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
12910 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
12911
12912 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
12913 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
12914 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
12915 methods and protocols.
12916
12917 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognised by the extension
12918 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
12919 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
12920 paragraph name.
12921
12922 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
12923 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
12924 at least M times and as many as N times.
12925
12926 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
12927 in files has changed slightly.
12928
12929 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
12930 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
12931 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
12932 with old time-stamp-format values.
12933
12934 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
12935 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
12936 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
12937 reasons.
12938
12939 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
12940 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
12941 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
12942 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
12943 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
12944 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
12945
12946 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
12947 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
12948 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
12949
12950 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
12951 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
12952 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
12953 recommended now will continue to work then.
12954
12955 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
12956 details.
12957
12958 ** There are some additional major modes:
12959
12960 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
12961 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
12962 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
12963
12964 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
12965 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
12966 into Emacs.
12967
12968 ** New Lisp packages include:
12969
12970 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
12971
12972 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
12973 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
12974
12975 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
12976
12977 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
12978 in shell buffers.
12979
12980 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
12981 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
12982 and `elint-defun'.
12983
12984 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
12985 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
12986 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
12987 strings or comments.
12988
12989 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
12990 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
12991 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
12992 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
12993 at these points.
12994
12995 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
12996 can visit them by short forms of their names.
12997
12998 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
12999 Emacs Lisp function at point.
13000
13001 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
13002
13003 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
13004 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
13005
13006 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
13007
13008 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
13009
13010 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
13011
13012 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
13013 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
13014
13015 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
13016 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
13017 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
13018 original place after inserting the copy.
13019
13020 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
13021 on the buffer.
13022
13023 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
13024 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
13025 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
13026
13027 Enable mouse-drag with:
13028 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
13029 -or-
13030 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
13031
13032 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
13033 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
13034
13035 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
13036 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
13037
13038 *** ogonek
13039
13040 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
13041 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
13042 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
13043 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
13044 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
13045 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
13046 instance) and vice versa.
13047
13048 To use this package load it using
13049 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
13050 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
13051 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
13052 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
13053 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
13054 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
13055
13056 *** Interface to ph.
13057
13058 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
13059
13060 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
13061 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
13062 these servers.
13063
13064 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
13065
13066 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
13067 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
13068 while the real cursor does not move.
13069
13070 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
13071 for visiting your favorite web sites.
13072
13073 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
13074 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
13075
13076 ** movemail change
13077
13078 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
13079 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
13080 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
13081 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
13082
13083 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
13084 \f
13085 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
13086
13087 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
13088
13089 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
13090 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
13091 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
13092 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
13093 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
13094
13095 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
13096 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
13097 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
13098 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
13099 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
13100 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
13101 \f
13102 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
13103
13104 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
13105 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
13106 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
13107 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
13108
13109 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
13110 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
13111
13112 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
13113 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
13114 "win".
13115
13116 ** Basic Lisp changes
13117
13118 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
13119 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
13120
13121 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
13122 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
13123 or by the user.
13124
13125 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
13126
13127 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
13128
13129 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
13130 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
13131
13132 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
13133 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
13134 its argument.
13135
13136 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
13137
13138 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
13139
13140 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
13141
13142 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
13143 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
13144 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
13145 `format' function.
13146
13147 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
13148 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
13149 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
13150
13151 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
13152 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
13153 adding one of these suffixes.
13154
13155 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
13156 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
13157 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
13158
13159 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
13160 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
13161
13162 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
13163
13164 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
13165 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
13166
13167 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
13168 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
13169
13170 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
13171
13172 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
13173 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
13174
13175 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
13176 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
13177 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
13178 works using `save-current-buffer'.
13179
13180 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
13181 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
13182 of the last form.
13183
13184 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
13185 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
13186 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
13187 as the last form.
13188
13189 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
13190 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
13191 matches.
13192
13193 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
13194
13195 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
13196 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
13197 Then it returns that string.
13198
13199 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
13200
13201 (with-output-to-string
13202 (princ "The buffer is ")
13203 (princ (buffer-name)))
13204
13205 returns "The buffer is foo".
13206
13207 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
13208 is non-nil.
13209
13210 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
13211 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
13212 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
13213
13214 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
13215 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
13216
13217 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
13218 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
13219 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
13220 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
13221 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
13222 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
13223
13224 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
13225 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
13226 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
13227 characters".
13228
13229 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
13230 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
13231 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
13232 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
13233 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
13234
13235 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
13236 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
13237 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
13238 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
13239
13240 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
13241 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
13242
13243 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
13244
13245 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
13246 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
13247 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
13248 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
13249 guaranteed.
13250
13251 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
13252 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
13253 character).
13254
13255 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
13256
13257 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
13258 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
13259 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
13260 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
13261 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
13262
13263 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
13264
13265 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
13266 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
13267 more than the number of characters.
13268
13269 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
13270 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
13271 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
13272 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
13273 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
13274 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
13275
13276 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
13277 and returns a string containing those characters.
13278
13279 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
13280 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
13281 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
13282 character, sref signals an error.
13283
13284 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
13285 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
13286 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13287
13288 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
13289 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
13290 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
13291
13292 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
13293 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
13294 to a vector of the characters in it.
13295
13296 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
13297 of a string. You call it as follows:
13298
13299 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
13300
13301 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
13302 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
13303 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
13304 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
13305 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
13306
13307 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
13308 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13309
13310 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
13311 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
13312
13313 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
13314 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
13315 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
13316 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
13317
13318 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
13319
13320 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
13321
13322 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
13323 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
13324 are not included in the resulting value.
13325
13326 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
13327 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
13328 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
13329 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
13330
13331 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
13332 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
13333 character extends across that column), then the padding character
13334 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
13335 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
13336 column START-COLUMN.
13337
13338 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
13339 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
13340 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
13341 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
13342 changed text, before the change.
13343
13344 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
13345 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
13346 one character set for each script, not for each language.
13347
13348 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
13349
13350 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
13351
13352 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
13353 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
13354
13355 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
13356 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
13357 which identify the character within that character set.
13358
13359 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
13360 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
13361 opposite of split-char.
13362
13363 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
13364 of all the characters between BEG and END.
13365
13366 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
13367 of all the characters in a string.
13368
13369 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
13370 and specifying coding systems.
13371
13372 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
13373 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
13374 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
13375 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
13376 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
13377 as what to do about code conversion.)
13378
13379 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
13380 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
13381
13382 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13383 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13384 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
13385
13386 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13387 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
13388 to match against a file name.
13389
13390 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13391 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13392 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13393 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13394 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13395 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13396
13397 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13398 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13399
13400 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
13401 the coding system to use for network sockets.
13402
13403 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
13404 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
13405 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
13406 service names.
13407
13408 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
13409 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
13410 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
13411 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
13412 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
13413 specifies the coding system for encoding.
13414
13415 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
13416 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
13417
13418 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
13419 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
13420 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
13421 start the subprocess.
13422
13423 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
13424 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
13425 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
13426 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
13427 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
13428
13429 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
13430 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
13431 subprocess.
13432
13433 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
13434 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
13435 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
13436 connection permanently or until overridden.
13437
13438 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
13439 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
13440 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
13441 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
13442 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
13443 system for one operation at a time.
13444
13445 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
13446 files, subprocesses or network connections.
13447
13448 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
13449 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
13450 The value is a cons cell,
13451 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
13452 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
13453 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
13454 input to the subprocess.
13455
13456 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
13457 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
13458
13459 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
13460 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
13461 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
13462
13463 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
13464 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
13465 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
13466 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
13467 customization.
13468
13469 Thus, instead of writing
13470
13471 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
13472 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
13473
13474 you would now write this:
13475
13476 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
13477 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
13478 :type 'boolean
13479 :group foo)
13480
13481 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
13482 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
13483 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
13484 for a description of them.
13485
13486 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
13487 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
13488
13489 (defgroup ispell nil
13490 "Spell checking using Ispell."
13491 :group 'processes)
13492
13493 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
13494 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
13495 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
13496 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
13497 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
13498
13499 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
13500 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
13501 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
13502 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
13503 first-level subgroups.
13504
13505 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
13506
13507 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
13508 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
13509
13510 ** easy-mmode
13511
13512 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
13513 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
13514 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
13515 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
13516 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
13517 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
13518
13519 ** Text property changes
13520
13521 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
13522 text property.
13523
13524 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
13525 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
13526 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
13527 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
13528 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
13529
13530 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
13531 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
13532 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
13533 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
13534
13535 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
13536 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
13537 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
13538
13539 ** Changes in invisibility features
13540
13541 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
13542 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
13543 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
13544 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
13545 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
13546 make the overlay visible.
13547
13548 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
13549 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
13550 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
13551 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
13552 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
13553 t when it should hide it.
13554
13555 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
13556
13557 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
13558 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
13559 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
13560 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
13561 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
13562 Here is an example of how to do this:
13563
13564 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
13565 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13566 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
13567 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13568
13569 ...
13570 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
13571
13572 ...
13573 ;; When done with the overlays:
13574 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
13575 ;; Or respectively:
13576 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
13577
13578 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
13579
13580 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
13581 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
13582 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
13583 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
13584
13585 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
13586 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
13587 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
13588
13589 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
13590 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
13591
13592 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
13593 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
13594
13595 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
13596 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
13597 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
13598
13599 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
13600 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
13601 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
13602 determine the syntax type of the character.
13603
13604 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
13605 of the current buffer.
13606
13607 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
13608 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
13609 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
13610
13611 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
13612 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
13613 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
13614 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
13615 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
13616
13617 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
13618 text property.
13619
13620 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
13621 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
13622 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
13623
13624 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
13625 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
13626 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
13627 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
13628 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
13629
13630 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
13631 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
13632 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
13633
13634 ** Changes in face features
13635
13636 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
13637 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
13638
13639 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
13640 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
13641
13642 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
13643 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
13644
13645 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
13646 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
13647
13648 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
13649 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
13650 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
13651 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
13652 overlay property).
13653
13654 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
13655 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
13656
13657 ** Changes in file-handling functions
13658
13659 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
13660 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
13661 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
13662 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
13663
13664 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
13665 begins with ~.
13666
13667 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
13668 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
13669
13670 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
13671 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
13672
13673 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
13674 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
13675
13676 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
13677 character code conversion as well as other things.
13678
13679 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
13680 (formerly it did not).
13681
13682 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
13683 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
13684
13685 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
13686 instead of constant strings.
13687
13688 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
13689 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
13690 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
13691
13692 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
13693 in the same way as before.
13694
13695 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
13696 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
13697 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
13698
13699 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
13700 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
13701 else, and returns nil.
13702
13703 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
13704 directory cannot be listed.
13705
13706 ** Changes in minibuffer input
13707
13708 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
13709 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
13710 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
13711 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
13712 ways:
13713
13714 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
13715 It is available through the history command M-n.
13716
13717 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
13718 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
13719 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
13720 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
13721 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
13722
13723 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
13724 argument in this way.
13725
13726 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
13727 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
13728 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
13729
13730 ** Echo area features
13731
13732 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
13733 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
13734 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
13735 after the echo area is cleared.
13736
13737 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
13738 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
13739
13740 ** Keyboard input features
13741
13742 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
13743 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
13744
13745 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
13746 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
13747 by keyboard macros.
13748
13749 ** Frame-related changes
13750
13751 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
13752 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
13753 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
13754
13755 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
13756 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
13757 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
13758
13759 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
13760 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
13761 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
13762 in the selected frame.
13763
13764 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
13765 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
13766 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
13767
13768 ** X Windows features
13769
13770 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
13771 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
13772 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
13773
13774 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
13775 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
13776
13777 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
13778 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
13779 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
13780
13781 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
13782 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
13783
13784 ** Subprocess features
13785
13786 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
13787 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
13788 automatically.
13789
13790 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
13791 and returns the output from the command as a string.
13792
13793 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
13794 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
13795
13796 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
13797 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
13798
13799 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
13800 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
13801 goes after the other menu items.
13802
13803 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
13804 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
13805 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
13806 are in use.
13807
13808 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
13809 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
13810
13811 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
13812 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
13813 form.
13814
13815 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
13816 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
13817 but its hook is still run.
13818
13819 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
13820 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
13821
13822 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
13823 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
13824 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
13825
13826 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
13827 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
13828 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
13829 warned.
13830
13831 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
13832 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
13833
13834 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
13835 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
13836 functions like display-time.
13837
13838 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
13839 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
13840
13841 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
13842 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
13843 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
13844
13845 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
13846 if there is an error in compilation.
13847
13848 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
13849 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
13850 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
13851 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
13852
13853 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
13854 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
13855 the *scratch* buffer.
13856
13857 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
13858 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
13859 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
13860 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
13861
13862 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
13863 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
13864 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
13865
13866 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
13867 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
13868 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
13869 and compose-mail-other-frame.
13870
13871 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
13872 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
13873 full name of the specified user will be returned.
13874
13875 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
13876 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
13877 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
13878 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
13879 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
13880 files at all.
13881
13882 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
13883 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
13884 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
13885 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
13886
13887 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
13888 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
13889 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
13890 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
13891
13892 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
13893
13894 ** imenu.el changes.
13895
13896 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
13897 item from menu created by imenu.
13898
13899 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
13900 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
13901 select one of those items.
13902 \f
13903 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
13904
13905 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
13906 Copyright information:
13907
13908 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13909
13910 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
13911 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
13912 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
13913 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.
13914
13915 Permission is granted to distribute modified versions
13916 of this document, or of portions of it,
13917 under the above conditions, provided also that they
13918 carry prominent notices stating who last changed them.
13919 \f
13920 Local variables:
13921 mode: outline
13922 paragraph-separate: "[ \f]*$"
13923 end:
13924
13925 arch-tag: 1aca9dfa-2ac4-4d14-bebf-0007cee12793